Version
as at 31 May 2023
Public Act 1994 No 143
Date of assentt 15 December 1994
Commencement see section 1(2)
Contents
Title
1Short Title and commencement
2Interpretation
3Associated definitions for communication works
4Meaning of cable programme service, and associated definitions [Repealed]
5Meaning of author
6Meaning of work of joint authorship
7Meaning of unknown authorship
8Meaning of copyright owner
9Meaning of issue to the public
10Meaning of publication
11Meaning of commercial publication
12Meaning of infringing copy
13Act to bind the Crown
Part 1
Description, ownership, and duration of copyright
Description of copyright
14Copyright in original works
15Recording necessary for some works
16Acts restricted by copyright
Qualification for copyright
17Qualification for copyright
18Qualification by reference to author
19Qualification by reference to country of first publication
20Qualification by reference to origin of communication work
Ownership of copyright
21First ownership of copyright
Duration of copyright
22Duration of copyright in literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic works
23Duration of copyright in sound recordings and films
24Duration of copyright in communication works
25Duration of copyright in typographical arrangement of published editions
Crown copyright
26Crown copyright
27No copyright in certain works
28Copyright vesting in certain international organisations
Part 2
Infringement of copyright
Primary infringement of copyright
29Infringement of copyright
30Infringement by copying
31nfringement by issue of copies to public
32Infringement by performance or playing or showing in public
33Infringement by communicating to public
34Infringement by making adaptation or act done in relation to adaptation
Secondary infringement of copyright
35Infringement by importation
36Possessing or dealing with infringing copy
37Providing means for making infringing copies
38Permitting use of premises for infringing performance
39Provision of apparatus for infringing performance, etc
Part 3
Acts permitted in relation to copyright works
40Provisions to be construed independently
41Incidental copying of copyright work
42Criticism, review, and news reporting
43Research or private study
43ATransient reproduction of work
Education
44Copying for educational purposes of literary, dramatic, musical or artistic works or typographical arrangements
44AStoring copies for educational purposes
45Copying for educational purposes of films and sound recordings
46Anthologies for educational use
47Performing, playing, or showing work in course of activities of educational establishment
48Copying and communication of communication work for educational purposes
49Things done for purposes of examination
Libraries and archives
50Interpretation
51Copying by librarians of parts of published works
52Copying by librarians of articles in periodicals
53Copying by librarians for users of other libraries
54Copying by librarians for collections of other libraries
55Copying by librarians or archivists to replace copies of works
56Copying by librarians or archivists of certain unpublished works
56ALibrary or archive may communicate digital copy to authenticated users
56BAdditional conditions for supply of copy of work in digital format by librarian or archivist under section 51, 52, or 56
56CAdditional condition for making digital copies under section 53 or 54
57Playing or showing sound recordings or films
57AMaking archived works available for public viewing
Public administration
58Copying by Parliamentary Library for members of Parliament
59Parliamentary and judicial proceedings
60Royal commissions and statutory inquiries
61Material open to public inspection or on official register
62Material communicated to the Crown in course of public business
63Use of copyright material for services of the Crown
64Rights of third parties in respect of Crown use
65Proceedings against the Crown
66Acts done under statutory authority
Literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic works
67Acts permitted on assumptions as to expiry of copyright or death of author in relation to anonymous or pseudonymous works
68Use of recording of spoken words in certain cases
69Authorised entity types
69AAccessible format copy activities by authorised entity
69BAccessible format copy activities by person who is not authorised entity
69CDuties of authorised entity in regard to records and fees
69DMinistry must publish list of authorised entities on Internet site
70Public reading or recitation
71Abstracts of scientific or technical articles
72Recordings of folk songs
73Representation of certain artistic works on public display
74Special exception from protection of literary or artistic works
75Special exception from protection of artistic work that has been applied industrially
76Special exception from protection of literary and artistic works relating to medicines
77Making of subsequent works by same artist 72
78Reconstruction of buildings
Computer programs, sound recordings, and films
79Rental by educational establishments and libraries
80Back-up copy of computer program
80ADecompilation of computer program
80BCopying or adapting computer program if necessary for lawful use
80CObserving, studying, or testing of computer program
80DCertain contractual terms relating to use of computer programs have no effect
81Playing of sound recordings for purposes of club, society, etc
81ACopying sound recording for personal use
Communication works
82Recording for purposes of maintaining standards in programmes
83Recording for purposes of complaining
84Recording for purposes of time shifting
85Incidental recording for purposes of communication
86Photographs of television broadcasts or cable programmes [Repealed]
87Free public playing or showing of communication work
87AFree public playing or showing of communication work that is simultaneous with reception
87BAssessment of damages for infringement of copyright in sound recording or film
88Reception and retransmission of broadcast in cable programme service
89Provision of subtitled copies of communication work
90Recording for archival purposes
91Recording by media monitors
Adaptations
92Adaptations
Internet service provider liability
92AInternet service provider must have policy for terminating accounts of repeat infringers [Repealed]
92BInternet service provider liability if user infringes copyright
92CInternet service provider liability for storing infringing material
92DRequirements for notice of infringement
92EInternet service provider does not infringe copyright by caching infringing material
Subsequent dealings
92Subsequent dealings with copies made under this Part
Part 4
Moral rights
Right to be identified as author or director
94Right to be identified as author or director
95Content of right to be identified
96Right must be asserted
97Exceptions to right to be identified
Right to object to derogatory treatment of work
98Right to object to derogatory treatment of work
99Content of right to object to derogatory treatment
100Exceptions to right to object to derogatory treatment of literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work
101Exceptions to right to object to derogatory treatment of films
False attribution
102False attribution of identity of author or director
103False representation as to literary, dramatic, or musical work
104False representations as to artistic work
Right to privacy of certain photographs and films
105Right to privacy of certain photographs and films
Supplementary provisions
106Duration of rights
107Consent and waiver of rights
108Application of provisions to joint works other than films
109Application of provisions to joint works that are films
110Application of provisions to parts of works
Part 5
Dealing with rights in copyright works
Licences to deal with copyright works
111Licences
112Warranty implied in certain licences
112ADamages for falsely claiming copyright ownership or licence
112BProvisions of sections 112 and 112A to have effect no matter what licence says
Transmission of copyright
113Transmission of copyright
114Assignment
115Copyright to pass under will with unpublished works
116Future copyright
117Right to make conditions in respect of certain unpublished works
Moral rights
118Moral rights not assignable
119Transmission of moral rights on death
Part 6
Remedies for infringement
Rights and remedies of copyright owner
120Infringement actionable by copyright owner
121Provisions as to damages in infringement proceedings
122Order for delivery up in civil proceedings
Infringing file sharing
122AInterpretation for sections 122B to 122U
122BOverview of infringing file sharing regime
122CIPAPs to send infringement notices
122DDetection notices
122EWarning notices
122FEnforcement notices
122GChallenging infringement notices
122HEffect of challenge to, and cancellation of, infringement notice
122IEnforcement action after issue of enforcement notice
122JApplication to Tribunal
122KNotice of proceedings
122LDecisions generally made on papers and without hearing
122MIf hearing is held
122NInfringement notice as evidence of copyright infringement
122OTribunal order requiring payment to rights owner
122P Court order suspending account holder’s account
122Q Order requiring IPAP to disclose account holder details
122R Suspension orders and orders under section 122Q not available until date set by Order in Council
122SApplication of section 122C to cellular mobile networks
122TObligations of IPAPs
122UFees payable by rights owners to IPAPs
Rights and remedies of exclusive licensee
123Rights and remedies of exclusive licensee
124Exercise of concurrent rights
Rights and remedies in relation to moral rights
125Infringement of moral rights actionable
Presumptions
126Presumptions relevant to literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic works
127Presumptions relevant to certain artistic works
128Presumptions relevant to computer programs, sound recordings, and films
129Presumptions relevant to works subject to Crown copyright
130Unjustified proceedings
Offences
131Criminal liability for making or dealing with infringing objects
131ATime for laying information [Repealed]
132Order for delivery up in criminal proceedings
133Liability of officers of body corporate
133AEvidence in proceedings
Disposal of infringing copy or other object
134Order as to disposal of infringing copy or other object
Part 6A
Enforcement officers
Appointment and functions of enforcement officers
134AChief executive may appoint enforcement officers
134BAuthority to act as enforcement officer
134CFunctions of enforcement officer
Enforcement officer’s power of entry and examination without warrant
134DEnforcement officer’s power of entry and examination without warrant
134EWhat enforcement officer and person assisting may do when exercising power of entry and examination without warrant
Entry and search under search warrant
134FEnforcement officer or member of Police may apply for search warrant
134GApplication for search warrant
134HMode of application for search warrant
134IForm and content of search warrant
134JTransmission of search warrant
134KRetention of documents
134LWhen search warrant is executed
134MPowers of entry and search under warrant
134NPowers of persons called to assist
General provisions that apply to powers of entry and search and entry and examination
134OApplication of sections 134P to 134S
134PPowers and duties of person exercising power of entry and search or power of entry and examination
134QInventory of things seized
134SCompliance with certain provisions may be deferred in certain circumstances
134SFurther extension to, or dispensation from, obligation to comply with certain provisions
Provisions relating to things seized
134TPeriod things seized may be retained
134UApplication for order to return things seized
134VDisposal of things seized
134WDisposal of perishable things
Other powers of enforcement officers
134XEnforcement officer may apply for production order
134YJudge may order documents to be produced
134ZPowers of enforcement officer to whom documents produced
134ZAOffence of failing to comply with order to produce documents
Powers of Police
134ZBPowers of Police
Miscellaneous
134ZCPrivilege against self-incrimination
134ZDOther privileges
134ZEDisclosure of information
134ZFNo liability if functions performed or powers exercised in good faith
Part 7
Border protection measures
135Definitions
135ADetention of items suspected of being pirated copies
135BNotice
135CRelease of items
136Notice may be given to chief executive
136AChief executive may suspend accepted notice
136BNotice of suspension
136CChief executive may reinstate accepted notice
136DDuration of accepted notice
137Determination whether item is pirated copy
138Limitations on requirement to supply information
139Notice of determination
140Detention of pirated copy
141Proceedings
141AForfeiture of goods by consent
142Powers of court
143Inspection of item
Enforcement powers of Customs officers
144Customs officer may seize goods in control of Customs
144AChief executive may require person to produce documents concerning goods in control of Customs
144BChief executive may require person to appear and answer questions concerning goods in control of Customs
144CCustoms officer may apply for production order
144DJudge may order documents to be produced
144EPowers of Customs officer to whom documents produced
144FIssue of search warrants to Customs officers
144GPrivilege against self-incrimination
144HOther privileges
144IOffences
Miscellaneous matters
145Delegation of powers, duties, and functions
146Protection of persons acting under authority of Act
Part 8
Copyright licensing
147Works of more than 1 author
References and applications with respect to licensing schemes
148Licensing schemes to which sections 149 to 155 apply
References with respect to licensing schemes
149Reference of proposed licensing scheme to Tribunal
150Reference of licensing scheme to Tribunal
151Further reference of scheme to Tribunal
152Effect of order of Tribunal made on reference
Applications with respect to licensing schemes
153Application for grant of licence in connection with licensing scheme
154Application for review of order as to entitlement to licence
155Effect of order of Tribunal made on application
References and applications with respect to licensing by licensing bodies
156Licences to which sections 157 to 160 apply
157Reference to Tribunal of proposed licence
158Reference to Tribunal of expiring licence
159Application for review of order as to licence
160Effect of order of Tribunal as to licence
Factors to be taken into account in certain classes of cases
161Unreasonable discrimination
162Licences for reprographic copying
163Licences for educational establishments in respect of works included in communication works
164Licences to reflect conditions imposed by promoters of events
165Licences to reflect payments in respect of underlying rights
166Licences in respect of works included in retransmissions
Implied indemnity in schemes or licences for reprographic copying
167Implied indemnity in certain schemes and licences for reprographic copying
168Determination of equitable remuneration
Part 9
Performers’ rights
169Interpretation
170General provisions relating to performers’ rights
Subpart 1—Performers’ moral rights
Right to be identified
170ARight to be identified as performer
170BContent of right to be identified as performer
170CRight to be identified as performer must be asserted
170DExceptions to right to be identified as performer
Right relating to derogatory treatment of performance
170ERight relating to derogatory treatment of performance
170FContent of right relating to derogatory treatment of performance
170GExceptions to right relating to derogatory treatment of performance
Other provisions relating to moral rights
170HConsent and waiver of rights
170IApplication to parts of performances
Subpart 2—Consent required for recording, live transmission, or
use of recording of performance
Performers’ rights
[Repealed]
171Consent required for recording or live transmission of performance
172Infringement by use of recording made without performer’s consent
Subpart 3—Performers’ rights relating to film
173Copying of film recordings
174Infringement by importing, possessing, or dealing with illicit recording
Subpart 4—Performers’ property rights relating to sound
recordings
174AApplication
174BConsent required to communicate or play sound recording to public
174CConsent required for copying of sound recording
174DConsent required for issue of copies to public
Subpart 5—Acts permitted in relation to performances
Acts permitted in relation to performances
[Repealed]
175Incidental copying of performance or recording
175ATransient reproduction of recording of performance
176Permitted acts in relation to performances, criticism, reviews, and news reporting
177Things done for purposes of instruction or examination
178Playing or showing sound recording, film, or communication work at educational establishment
179Recording of communication works by educational establishment
180Subsequent dealings
181Parliamentary and judicial proceedings
182Royal commissions and statutory inquiries
183Acts done under statutory authority
184Use of recordings of spoken works in certain cases
185Recordings of folk songs
186Playing of sound recordings for purposes of club, society, etc
187Incidental recording for purposes of communication work
188Free public playing or showing of communication work
188AFree public playing or showing of communication work that is simultaneous with reception
188BAssessment of damages for infringement of rights under subparts 2 to 4 in relation to performance or recording
189Reception and retransmission of broadcast in cable programme service [Repealed]
190Provision of subtitled copies of communication work
191Recording of communication work for archival purposes
192Power of Tribunal to give consent on behalf of performer
192AOther acts permitted in relation to performers’ property rights
Subpart 6—Miscellaneous provisions
Duration and transmission of rights
193Duration of rights 206
194Transmission of performers’ rights
194AMoral rights not assignable
194BTransmission of moral rights on death
194CPerformers’ rights relating to consent for recording or live transmission and to film recordings not assignable
194DTransmission of performers’ rights relating to consent for recording or live transmission and to film recordings on death
194ETransmission of performers’ property rights
194FAssignment
194GPerformers’ property rights to pass under will with unpublished original recording
194HFuture property rights
Licences
194ILicences
194JRights and remedies of exclusive licensee 209
194KExercise of concurrent rights
Consent and waiver
195Consent and waiver
Remedies for infringement
196Proceedings for infringement of performers’ rights
196AProceedings against the Crown
197Order for delivery up in civil proceedings
Presumptions
197APresumptions relevant to performances
Offences
198Criminal liability for making, dealing with, using, or copying illicit recordings
199Order for delivery up in criminal proceedings
200False representation of authority to give consent
201Liability of officers of body corporate
201AEvidence in proceedings
202Order as to disposal of illicit recording
Application to foreign countries
203Application of this Part to convention countries [Repealed]
204Application of Part 9 to other entities
Part 10
Copyright Tribunal
Constitution
205Copyright Tribunal
206Membership of Tribunal
207Term of office of members of Tribunal
208Vacation of office
209Appointment of temporary acting chairperson or members
209ADelegation by chairperson of Tribunal
210Remuneration and travelling allowances
Jurisdiction and procedure
211Jurisdiction of Tribunal
211AOrderly and efficient operation
212Parties to proceedings
213Hearing
214Procedure of Tribunal
214ATribunal may strike out, determine, or adjourn proceeding
215Evidence in proceedings before Tribunal
216Witness summons
217Service of summons
218Witnesses’ allowances
219Privileges and immunities
220Non-attendance or refusal to co-operate
221Contempt of Tribunal
222Costs
222APower to award interest
223Stating case for High Court
224Appeal on question of law
Practice notes, procedural information, and publication of decisions
224APractice notes
224BOnline publication of information about procedures, time frames, and progress of decisions
224COnline publication of final written decisions
Part 11
Miscellaneous provisions
225Rights and privileges under other enactments or common law
Technological protection measures
226Interpretation for sections 226A to 226E
226AProhibited conduct in relation to technological protection measure
226BRights of issuer of TPM work
226COffence of contravening section 226A
226DWhen rights of issuer of TPM work do not apply
226EUser’s options if prevented from exercising permitted act by TPM
Copyright management information
226FMeaning of copyright management information
226GInterference with CMI prohibited
226HCommercial dealing in work subject to CMI interference
226IContravention of section 226G or 226H
226JOffence of dealing in work subject to CMI interference
227Offence of fraudulently receiving programmes
228Rights and remedies in respect of apparatus, etc, for unauthorised reception of transmissions
Other countries
229Supplementary provisions as to fraudulent reception
230Application to convention countries
231Expenditure or liability incurred in connection with copyright work
232Application of Act (other than Part 9) to other entities
233Denial of copyright to persons connected with countries not giving adequate protection to New Zealand works
234Regulations 244
Transitional provisions and savings
235Transitional provisions and savings
236Consequential amendments and repeals
Schedule 1
Transitional provisions and savings
Schedule 2
Enactments amended
Schedule 3
Enactments repealed
Schedule 4
Regulations revoked
An Act to consolidate and amend the law relating to copyright
__________________
Note
The Parliamentary Counsel Office has made editorial and format changes to this version using the powers under subpart 2 of Part 3 of the Legislation Act 2019.
Note 4 at the end of this version provides a list of the amendments included in it.
This Act is administered by the Ministry of Business, Innovation, and Employment.
(1)This Act may be cited as the Copyright Act 1994.
(2)Except as provided in sections 27(2) and 144(5), this Act shall come into force on 1 January 1995.
(1)In this Act, unless the context otherwise requires,—
accessible format copy means a copy of a published literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work, or a part of the work, in an alternative manner or form that gives persons who have a print disability access to the work
adaptation,—
Archives New Zealand has the same meaning as in section 4 of the Public Records Act 2005
article, in relation to an article in a periodical, includes an item of any description
artistic work—
authorised, with respect to anything done in relation to a work, means done—
authorised entity means—
building includes—
business includes a trade or profession
charitable entity has the meaning given in section 4(1) of the Charities Act 2005
chief executive,—
CMI or copyright management information has the meaning given to it in section 226F
collective work means—
communicate means to transmit or make available by means of a communication technology, including by means of a telecommunications system or electronic retrieval system, and communication has a corresponding meaning
communication work means a transmission of sounds, visual images, or other information, or a combination of any of those, for reception by members of the public, and includes a broadcast or a cable programme
compilation includes—
computer-generated, in relation to a work, means that the work is generated by computer in circumstances such that there is no human author of the work
convention country, except in Part 9, means an entity that is a party to an international agreement or arrangement relating to copyright
copying—
and copy and copies have corresponding meanings
copyright licence means a licence to do, or authorise the doing of, any restricted act
copyright work means a work of any of the descriptions in section 14(1) in which copyright exists
country includes every territory for whose international relations the Government of that country is responsible
Crown—
Crown entity has the same meaning as it has in section 2(1) of the Public Finance Act 1989
director, in relation to a copyright work that is a film, includes any person nominated by the director of the film to exercise the director’s rights under Part 4 if—
document, for the purposes of Part 6A and sections 144A and 144C to 144E, means—
dramatic work includes—
educational establishment means—
educational resource supplier means any person—
electronic means actuated by electric, magnetic, electro-magnetic, electrochemical, or electro-mechanical energy; and in electronic form means in a form usable only by electronic means
employed means employed under a contract of service or a contract of apprenticeship; and employee, employer, and employment have corresponding meanings
exclusive licence means a licence in writing, signed by or on behalf of a copyright owner, authorising the licensee, to the exclusion of all other persons (including the copyright owner), to exercise a right that would otherwise be exercisable exclusively by the copyright owner
facsimile copy includes a copy that is reduced or enlarged in scale
film means a recording on any medium from which a moving image may by any means be produced
future copyright means copyright that will or may come into existence in respect of a future work or a class of future work or on the occurrence of a future event
Government means the Executive Government of New Zealand
government department means any department or instrument of the Government, or any branch or division of any such department or instrument; but does not include—
graphic work includes—
infringing copy has the meaning given by section 12
instruction means—
international organisation means an organisation the members of which include 1 or more States
Internet service provider means a person who does either or both of the following things:
judicial proceedings includes—
lawful user, in relation to a computer program, means a person who has a right to use the program, whether under a copyright licence or otherwise
licensing body means a body of persons (whether corporate or unincorporate) that, as copyright owner or prospective copyright owner or as agent for a copyright owner,—
licensing scheme means a scheme setting out—
and for the purpose of this definition a scheme includes anything in the nature of a scheme, whether described as a scheme or as a tariff or by any other name literary work means any work, other than a dramatic or musical work, that is written, spoken, or sung; and includes—
Marrakesh Treaty country means a Contracting Party to the Marrakesh Treaty to Facilitate Access to Published Works for Persons Who Are Blind, Visually Impaired, or Otherwise Print Disabled, done at Marrakesh on 27 June 2013
material time,—
Minister means the Minister of the Crown who, under the authority of any warrant or with the authority of the Prime Minister, is for the time being responsible for the administration of this Act
Ministerial inquiry includes the proceedings of a committee set up by the Government or a Minister or Ministers to inquire into or advise on any matter
Ministry means the department of State that, with the authority of the Prime Minister, is responsible for the administration of the Act
musical work means a work consisting of music, exclusive of any words intended to be sung or spoken with the music or any actions intended to be performed with the music
New Zealand includes Tokelau
Office of Parliament means—
performance, except in Part 9,—
photograph means a recording of light or other radiation on any medium on which an image is produced or from which an image may by any means be produced; but does not include a film or part of a film
plate includes any stereotype, stone, block, mould, matrix, transfer, negative, or other similar appliance
prescribed foreign country means any country (other than New Zealand)—
print disability, in relation to a person,—
proceedings includes a counterclaim; and references to the plaintiff and to the defendant in proceedings shall be construed accordingly
published edition means a published edition of the whole or any part of 1 or more literary, dramatic, or musical works
regulations includes any other secondary legislation or instruments published under Part 2 of the Legislation Act 2012 or under any corresponding former enactment
rental means any arrangement under which a copy of a work is made available—
on terms that it will or may be returned
reprographic copy means a copy made by a reprographic process; and
reprographic copying has a corresponding meaning
reprographic process means a process—
sculpture includes a cast or model made for purposes of sculpture sound recording means—
regardless of the medium on which the recording is made or the method by which the sounds are reproduced or produced
statutory inquiry means an inquiry held or investigation conducted in pursuance of a duty imposed or power conferred by or under an enactment
sufficient acknowledgement, in relation to a work, means an acknowledgement identifying—
telecommunications system means a system for conveying visual images, sounds, or other information by electronic means
TPM or technological protection measure has the meaning given to it in section 226
TPM circumvention device has the meaning given to it in section 226
TPM work has the meaning given to it in section 226
transcript means a written record of words spoken on a recording
Tribunal means the Copyright Tribunal continued by section 205
unauthorised, with respect to anything done in relation to a work, means done otherwise than—
wireless communication means the sending of electromagnetic energy over paths not provided by a material substance constructed or arranged for that purpose
working day means any day of the week other than—
(ab)if Waitangi Day or Anzac Day falls on a Saturday or a Sunday, the following Monday; and
writing includes any form of notation or code, whether by hand or otherwise and regardless of the method by which, or medium in or on which, it is recorded; and written has a corresponding meaning.
(2)References in this Act to the time at which a literary, dramatic, or musical work is made are to the time at which the work is recorded, in writing or otherwise.
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 2(1), 3(6), 3(8), 17(1), 24(5), 26(9), 36(1); 1989 No 44 s 2; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 ss 1(2), 3(1), 3(2), 4, 5(1), 6(1), 8(1), 16(1), 19(2), 21(3), 21(4), 92(1), 178 (UK)
Section 2(1) accessible format copy: inserted, on 4 January 2020, by section 4 of the Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43).
Section 2(1) Archives New Zealand: inserted, on 21 April 2005, by section 67(1) of the Public Records Act 2005 (2005 No 40).
Section 2(1) authorised entity: inserted, on 4 January 2020, by section 4 of the Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43).
Section 2(1) broadcast: repealed, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) charitable entity: inserted, on 4 January 2020, by section 4 of the Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43).
Section 2(1) chief executive: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 4 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 2(1) CMI or copyright management information: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) communicate: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) communication work: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) convention country: substituted, on 14 October 1999, by section 3(2) of the Copyright Amendment Act 1999 (1999 No 124).
Section 2(1) copying paragraph (a): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(3) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) copying paragraph (b): repealed, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(3) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) copying paragraph (d): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(4) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) Crown paragraph (b): amended, on 5 August 2013, by section 77(3) of the Legislation Act 2012 (2012 No 119).
Section 2(1) document: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 4 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 2(1) educational establishment: replaced, on 1 August 2020, by section 668 of the Education and Training Act 2020 (2020 No 38).
Section 2(1) educational resource supplier: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) government department paragraph (c): substituted, on 1 March 2002, by section 170(1) of the Public Trust Act 2001 (2001 No 100).
Section 2(1) government department paragraph (e): inserted, on 5 August 2013, by section 77(3) of the Legislation Act 2012 (2012 No 119).
Section 2(1) infringing copy: inserted, on 19 May 1998, by section 3 of the Copyright (Removal of Prohibition on Parallel Importing) Amendment Act 1998 (1998 No 20).
Section 2(1) Internet service provider: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) Marrakesh Treaty country: inserted, on 4 January 2020, by section 4 of the Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43).
Section 2(1) material time paragraph (c): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(5) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) material time paragraph (d): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(5) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) material time paragraph (e): repealed, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(5) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) Minister: substituted, on 1 October 1995, by section 10(3) of the Department of Justice (Restructuring) Act 1995 (1995 No 39).
Section 2(1) Ministry: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 4 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 2(1) National Archives: repealed, on 21 April 2005, by section 67(1) of the Public Records Act 2005 (2005 No 40).
Section 2(1) Office of Parliament paragraph (c): substituted, on 1 July 2001, by section 53 of the Public Audit Act 2001 (2001 No 10).
Section 2(1) Office of Parliament paragraph (d): repealed, on 5 August 2013, by section 77(3) of the Legislation Act 2012 (2012 No 119).
Section 2(1) performance paragraph (b): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(6) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) print disability: inserted, on 4 January 2020, by section 4 of the Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43).
Section 2(1) regulations: replaced, on 5 August 2013, by section 77(3) of the Legislation Act 2012 (2012 No 119).
Section 2(1) regulations: amended, on 28 October 2021, by section 3 of the Secondary Legislation Act 2021 (2021 No 7).
Section 2(1) TPM or technological protection measure: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) TPM circumvention device: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) TPM work: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 4(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 2(1) working day paragraph (a): replaced, on 12 April 2022, by wehenga 7 o Te Ture mō te Hararei Tūmatanui o te Kāhui o Matariki 2022/section 7 of the Te Kāhui o Matariki Public Holiday Act 2022 (2022 No 14).
Section 2(1) working day paragraph (ab): inserted, on 1 January 2014, by section 8 of the Holidays (Full Recognition of Waitangi Day and ANZAC Day) Amendment Act 2013 (2013 No 19).
(1)References in this Act to a person making a communication work are—
(2)For the purposes of this Act, in the case of communicating a work by satellite transmission,—
Section 3: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 5 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
[Repealed]
Section 4: repealed, on 31 October 2008, by section 6 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)For the purposes of this Act, the author of a work is the person who creates it.
(2)For the purposes of subsection (1), the person who creates a work shall be taken to be,—
(3)The author of a work of any of the descriptions referred to in subsection (2) may be a natural person or a body corporate.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 9(1)–(3) (UK)
Section 5(2)(c): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 7 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 5(2)(d): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 7 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 5(2)(e): repealed, on 31 October 2008, by section 7 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)In this Act, the term work of joint authorship means a work produced by the collaboration of 2 or more authors in which the contribution of each author is not distinct from that of the other author or authors.
(2)A communication work must be treated as a work of joint authorship in any case where more than 1 person is to be taken as making the communication work.
(3)References in this Act to the author of a work shall be construed in relation to a work of joint authorship as a reference to all the authors of the work.
(4)Where, in relation to a work of joint authorship, copyright would not exist in the work if 1 or more of the authors were the sole author or sole joint authors, the work shall be treated as if the other author or authors were the sole author or sole joint authors of the work.
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 12(3), (4), (6); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 10 (UK)
Section 6(2): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 8 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)For the purposes of this Act, a work is of unknown authorship if the identity of the author is unknown or, in the case of a work of joint authorship, if the identity of none of the authors is known.
(2)For the purposes of this Act, the identity of an author shall be regarded as unknown if it is not possible for a person who wishes to ascertain the identity of the author to do so by reasonable inquiry; but if that identity is once known it shall not subsequently be regarded as unknown.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 11(3), (4); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 9(4), (5) (UK)
(1)Where copyright or any aspect of copyright is owned by more than 1 person jointly, references in this Act to the copyright owner, or to the owner of the copyright in the work, are to all owners.
(2)Where different persons are entitled to different aspects of copyright in a work, the copyright owner for any purpose of this Act is the person who is entitled to the aspect of copyright relevant for that purpose.
(3)Subject to the provisions of Part 7, where a question arises under this Act whether an object of any description has been imported, sold, or otherwise dealt with other than pursuant to a copyright licence, the copyright owner shall be taken to be the person entitled to the copyright in respect of its application to the making of objects of that description in the country into which the object was imported or in which it was sold or otherwise dealt with.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 3(10); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 173 (UK)
(1)References in this Act to the issue of copies of a work to the public mean the act of putting into circulation copies not previously put into circulation; and do not include the acts of—
(2)The issue of copies of a work to the public, in relation to computer programs, includes the rental of copies of computer programs to the public and rental subsequent to those works having been put into circulation; but does not include any such rental where—
(3)The issue of copies of a work to the public, in relation to sound recordings and films, includes the rental of copies of those works to the public and rental subsequent to those works having been put into circulation.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 18(2) (UK)
Section 9(1)(c): amended, on 19 May 1998, by section 4 of the Copyright (Removal of Prohibition on Parallel Importing) Amendment Act 1998 (1998 No 20).
Section 9(1)(d): added, on 19 May 1998, by section 4 of the Copyright (Removal of Prohibition on Parallel Importing) Amendment Act 1998 (1998 No 20).
Section 9(2): amended, on 31 October 2003, by section 3(1) of the Copyright (Parallel Importation of Films and Onus of Proof) Amendment Act 2003 (2003 No 111).
Section 9(3): amended, on 31 October 2003, by section 3(2) of the Copyright (Parallel Importation of Films and Onus of Proof) Amendment Act 2003 (2003 No 111).
(1)In this Act, the term publication, in relation to a work,—
and publish has a corresponding meaning.
(2)In the case of a work of architecture in the form of a building, or an artistic work incorporated in a building, construction of the building shall be treated as equivalent to publication of the work.
(3)References in this Act to publication do not include publication that is not intended to satisfy the reasonable requirements of the public.
(4)The following acts do not constitute publication for the purposes of this Act:
the issue to the public of copies of a graphic work representing, or of photographs of, the work:
(5)No account shall be taken for the purposes of this section of any unauthorised act.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 3(1), (2), (5), (6); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 175(1), (3)–(6) (UK)
Section 10(4)(a)(ii): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 9(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 10(4)(b)(iii): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 9(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 10(4)(d)(ii): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 9(3) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
In this Act, the term commercial publication, in relation to a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work, means the publication of the work consisting of—
and related expressions shall be construed accordingly.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 175(2) (UK)
(1)In this Act, the term infringing copy, in relation to a copyright work, shall be construed in accordance with this section.
(2)An object is an infringing copy if its making constitutes an infringement of the copyright in the work in question.
(3)An object that a person imports, or proposes to import, into New Zealand is an infringing copy if—
(4)Where in any proceedings the question arises whether an object is an infringing copy, and it is shown—
it shall be presumed until the contrary is proved that the object was made at a time when copyright existed in the work.
(5)In this Act, an infringing copy includes a copy falling to be treated as an infringing copy under any of the following provisions of this Act:
(5A)An object that a person imports or proposes to import into New Zealand is not an infringing copy under subsection (3)(b) if—
(6)In this Act, an infringing copy does not include a literary work or an artistic work that—
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 10(5); 1990 No 71 s 2; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 27 (UK)
Section 12(3): substituted, on 19 May 1998, by section 5(1) of the Copyright (Removal of Prohibition on Parallel Importing) Amendment Act 1998 (1998 No 20).
Section 12(5)(a): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 10 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 12(5A): inserted, on 19 May 1998, by section 5(2) of the Copyright (Removal of Prohibition on Parallel Importing) Amendment Act 1998 (1998 No 20).
This Act binds the Crown.
(1)Copyright is a property right that exists, in accordance with this Act, in original works of the following descriptions:
(2)A work is not original if—
(3)[Repealed]
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 7(1), 13(1), 14(1), 15(1), 17(1); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 ss 1(1), 5(2), 6(6), 7(6), 8(2) (UK)
Section 14(1): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 11(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 14(3): repealed, on 31 October 2008, by section 11(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)Copyright does not exist in a literary or dramatic or musical work unless and until the work is recorded, in writing or otherwise.
(2)It is immaterial for the purposes of subsection (1) whether the work is recorded by or with the consent of the author.
(3)Where a work is not recorded by the author, the question whether copyright exists in the record, as distinct from the work recorded, is not affected by anything in subsection (1).
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 3(2), (3) (UK)
(1)The owner of the copyright in a work has the exclusive right to do, in accordance with sections 30 to 34, the following acts in New Zealand:
(2)Subsection (1) applies subject to Parts 3 and 8.
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 6(1), 7(3), 7(4), 13(5), 14(5), 17(3); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 16(1), (4) (UK)
Section 16(1)(f): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 12 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)Copyright does not exist in a work unless the requirements of section 18 or section 19 or section 20 are satisfied in respect of that work.
(2)Subsection (1) does not apply to copyright that exists by virtue of section 26 or section 28.
(3)If the requirements of section 18 or section 19 or section 20 or section 26 or section 28 are once satisfied in respect of a work, copyright in that work does not cease to exist if any change occurs in any of the circumstances by reason of which those requirements were satisfied.
(4)For the avoidance of doubt, it is hereby declared that where any other provision of this Act imposes requirements, in addition to the requirements of section 18 or section 19 or section 20, that must be satisfied for copyright to exist in a work, copyright does not exist in a work unless the requirements of that provision and the requirements of section 18 or section 19 or section 20 are satisfied in respect of that work.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 153 (UK)
(1)A work qualifies for copyright if the author is, at the material time,—
(2)A work qualifies for copyright if the author is, at the material time,—
(3)Subject to subsection (4), a work of joint authorship qualifies for copyright if, at the material time, any of the authors satisfies the requirements of subsection (1) or subsection (2).
(4)Where a work of joint authorship qualifies for copyright under this section alone, only those authors who satisfy the requirements of subsection (1) or subsection (2) shall be taken into account for the purposes of the application, to that work, of the following provisions of this Act:
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 7(1), 12(1), 13(1), 14(1), 15(1), 17(1); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 154 (UK)
(1)A work (being a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work, a sound recording, a film, or a typographical arrangement of a published edition) qualifies for copyright if it is first published—
(2)For the purposes of this section, publication in one country shall not be regarded as other than the first publication by reason of simultaneous publication elsewhere; and for this purpose publication elsewhere within the previous 30 days shall be treated as simultaneous.
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 7(2), 13(2), 14(2), 17(1); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 155 (UK)
A communication work qualifies for copyright if it is made from—
Section 20: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 13 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)Subject to the provisions of this section, the person who is the author of a work is the first owner of any copyright in the work.
(2)Where an employee makes, in the course of his or her employment, a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work, that person’s employer is the first owner of any copyright in the work.
(3)Where—
that person is the first owner of any copyright in the work.
(4)Subsections (2) and (3) apply subject to any agreement to the contrary.
(5)Subsections (1) to (4) apply subject to sections 26 and 28.
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 9, 13(4), 14(4); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 11 (UK)
(1)Subject to the following provisions of this section, copyright in a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work expires at the end of the period of 50 years from the end of the calendar year in which the author dies.
(2)If the work is computer-generated, copyright expires at the end of the period of 50 years from the end of the calendar year in which the work is made.
(3)If the work is of unknown authorship, copyright expires at the end of the period of 50 years from the end of the calendar year in which it is first made available to the public by an authorised act.
(4)For the purposes of subsection (3), the circumstances in which a work may be made available to the public include,—
(5)If—
subsection (1) does not apply to revive copyright in the work.
(6)In relation to a work of joint authorship,—
(7)This section does not apply to copyright in a work to which section 26 or section 28 applies.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 8(1); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 12 (UK)
Section 22(4): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 14 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)Copyright in a sound recording or film expires—
whichever is the later.
(2)For the purposes of subsection (1), a sound recording or film is made available to the public when—
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 13(3), 14(3); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 13 (UK)
Section 23(2): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 15 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)Copyright in a communication work expires at the end of the period of 50 years from the end of the calendar year in which the communication work is first communicated to the public.
(2)Copyright in a repeated communication work expires at the same time as copyright in the initial communication work expires.
(3)There is no copyright in a repeated communication work that is communicated to the public after copyright in the initial communication work has expired.
Section 24: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 16 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Copyright in a typographical arrangement of a published edition expires at the end of the period of 25 years from the end of the calendar year in which the edition is first published.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 17(2); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 15 (UK)
(1)Where a work is made by a person employed or engaged by the Crown under a contract of service, a contract of apprenticeship, or a contract for services,—
(2)Copyright in such a work is referred to in this Act as Crown copyright, notwithstanding that such copyright is assigned to another person.
(3)Crown copyright shall expire,—
(4)In the case of a work of joint authorship where 1 or more, but not all, of the authors are persons employed or engaged by the Crown under a contract of service, a contract of apprenticeship, or a contract for services, this section applies only in relation to those authors and the copyright existing by virtue of their contribution to the work.
(5)Subject to this section and to any other express provision of this Act, the provisions of this Act apply in relation to Crown copyright as to other copyright.
(6)Subsection (1) applies subject to any agreement to the contrary.
(7)This section is subject to section 27.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 52; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 163 (UK)
(1)No copyright exists in any of the following works, whenever those works were made:
(1A)No Crown copyright exists in any work, whenever that work was made,—
(1B)Except as specified in subsection (1A), nothing in subsection (1) affects copyright in any work that is incorporated by reference in a work referred to in subsection (1).
(1C)Subsection (1A) does not affect copyright in any New Zealand Standard (as that term is defined in the Standards and Accreditation Act 2015).
(2)Subsection (1) shall come into force on a date to be appointed by the GovernorGeneral by Order in Council; and 1 or more Orders in Council may be made appointing different dates for different paragraphs of that subsection.
(3)An order under this section is secondary legislation (see Part 3 of the Legislation Act 2019 for publication requirements).
| Legislation Act 2019 requirements for secondary legislation made under this section | ||
| Publication | PCO must publish it on the legislation website and notify it in the Gazette | LA19 s 69(1)(c) |
| Presentation | The Minister must present it to the House of Representatives | LA19s 114, Sch 1 cl 32(1)(a) |
| Disallowance | It may be disallowed by the House of Representatives | LA19 ss 115, 116 |
| This note is not part of the Act. | ||
Section 27(1): brought into force, on 1 April 2001, by the Copyright Act Commencement Order 2000 (SR 2000/245).
Section 27(1)(b): replaced, on 28 October 2021, by section 3 of the Secondary Legislation Act 2021 (2021 No 7).
Section 27(1)(d): repealed, on 28 October 2021, by section 3 of the Secondary Legislation Act 2021 (2021 No 7).
Section 27(1)(h): amended, on 27 August 2013, by section 39 of the Inquiries Act 2013 (2013 No 60).
Section 27(1)(i): inserted, on 27 August 2013, by section 39 of the Inquiries Act 2013 (2013 No 60).
Section 27(1A): inserted, on 14 April 2005, by section 3 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2005 (2005 No 33).
Section 27(1B): inserted, on 14 April 2005, by section 3 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2005 (2005 No 33).
Section 27(1C): inserted, on 1 March 2016, by section 44(2) of the Standards and Accreditation Act 2015 (2015 No 91).
Section 27(3): inserted, on 28 October 2021, by section 3 of the Secondary Legislation Act 2021 (2021 No 7).
(1)Where an original work (being a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work or a film) is made by an officer or employee of, or is published by, an international organisation to which this section applies,—
(2)The copyright of an international organisation under this section shall expire,—
(3)Subject to this section and to any other express provision of this Act, the provisions of this Act apply in relation to the copyright of an international organisation under this section.
(4)An international organisation to which this section applies shall be deemed to have, and to have had at all material times, the legal capacities of a body corporate for the purposes of holding, dealing with, and enforcing copyright and in connection with all legal proceedings relating to copyright.
(5)The Governor-General may from time to time, by Order in Council,—
(6)An order under this section is secondary legislation (see Part 3 of the Legislation Act 2019 for publication requirements).
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 50; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 168 (UK)
| Legislation Act 2019 requirements for secondary legislation made under this section | ||
| Publication | PCO must publish it on the legislation website and notify it in the Gazette | LA19 s 69(1)(c) |
| Presentation | The Minister must present it to the House of Representatives | LA19s 114, Sch 1 cl 32(1)(a) |
| Disallowance | It may be disallowed by the House of Representatives | LA19 ss 115, 116 |
| This note is not part of the Act. | ||
Section 28(6): inserted, on 28 October 2021, by section 3 of the Secondary Legislation Act 2021 (2021 No 7).
(1)Copyright in a work is infringed by a person who, other than pursuant to a copyright licence, does any restricted act.
(2)References in this Act to the doing of a restricted act are to the doing of that act—
and it is immaterial whether any intervening acts themselves infringe copyright.
(3)This Part is subject to Parts 3 and 8.
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 3(1); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 16(2), (3), (4) (UK)
The copying of a work is a restricted act in relation to every description of copyright work.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 17(1) (UK)
The issue of copies of a work to the public is a restricted act in relation to every description of copyright work.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 18(1) (UK)
(1)The performance of a work in public is a restricted act only in relation to a literary, dramatic, or musical work.
(2)The playing or showing of a work in public is a restricted act only in relation to a sound recording, film, or communication work.
(3)Where copyright in a work is infringed by the performance, playing, or showing of the work in public by means of apparatus for receiving visual images or sounds conveyed by electronic or other means,—
shall not be regarded as responsible for the infringement.
(4)For the purposes of subsection (3), a person who sends visual images or sounds does not include a person who retransmits visual images or sounds.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Acts 1988 s 19(1), (3), (4) (UK)
Section 32(2): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 17 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Communicating a work to the public is a restricted act in relation to every description of copyright work.
Section 33: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 18 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The making of an adaptation of a work is a restricted act only in relation to a literary, dramatic, or musical work.
(2)For the purposes of subsection (1), an adaptation is made when it is recorded, in writing or otherwise.
(3)The doing of any of the acts specified in any of sections 30 to 33 or in subsection (1), in relation to an adaptation of a work, is also a restricted act in relation to the literary, dramatic, or musical work from which the adaptation was made.
(4)For the purposes of subsection (3), where the act done in relation to an adaptation of a work is an act specified in section 32 or section 33, it is immaterial whether the adaptation has been recorded, in writing or otherwise, at the time the act is done.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 21(1), (2) (UK)
(1)A person infringes copyright in a work if—
(2)In civil proceedings for infringement of copyright under subsection (1), in the case of a work that is a sound recording, film, or computer program to which subsection (6) applies,—
(3)[Repealed]
(4)[Repealed]
(5)Subsections (3) and (4) are repealed on 31 October 2016.
(6)This subsection applies to the following sound recordings, films, and computer programs:
Section 35: substituted, on 31 October 2003, by section 4 of the Copyright (Parallel Importation of Films and Onus of Proof) Amendment Act 2003 (2003 No 111).
Section 35(1)(c): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 19(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 35(3): repealed, on 31 October 2016, by section 35(5).
Section 35(4): repealed, on 31 October 2016, by section 35(5).
Section 35(5): substituted, on 12 April 2008, by section 19(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 35(5): amended, on 31 October 2013, by section 4(2) of the Copyright (Parallel Importing of Films) Amendment Act 2013 (2013 No 86).
Copyright in a work is infringed by a person who, in New Zealand, other than pursuant to a copyright licence,—
an object that is, and that the person knows or has reason to believe is, an infringing copy of the work.
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 10(3), (4), 18(3), (4); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 23 (UK)
(1)Copyright in a work is infringed by a person who, other than pursuant to a copyright licence,—
an object specifically designed or adapted for making copies of that work, knowing or having reason to believe that the object is to be used to make such infringing copies.
(2)Copyright in a work is infringed by a person who, other than under a copyright licence, communicates a work to 1 or more persons, knowing or having reason to believe that infringing copies will be made by means of the reception of the communication in New Zealand or elsewhere.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 24 (UK)
Section 37(2): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 20 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)Where copyright in a literary, dramatic, or musical work is infringed by a performance at a place of public entertainment, any person who gave permission for that place to be used for the performance is also liable for the infringement unless, when the person gave that permission, he or she believed on reasonable ,, grounds that the performance would not infringe copyright.
(2)In this section, the term place of public entertainment includes premises that are occupied mainly for purposes other than public entertainment but are from time to time made available for hire for the purposes of public entertainment.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 25 (UK)
(1)Where copyright in a work is infringed by a performance of the work in public, or by the playing or showing of the work in public, by means of apparatus for—
the persons described in subsections (2) to (4) are also liable for the infringement.
(2)A person who supplied the apparatus, or any substantial part of it, is liable for the infringement if, when he or she supplied the apparatus or part,—
(3)An occupier of premises who gave permission for the apparatus to be brought onto the premises is liable for the infringement if, when the occupier gave that permission, he or she knew, or had reason to believe, that the apparatus was likely to be so used as to infringe copyright.
(4)A person who supplied a copy of a sound recording or film used to infringe copyright is liable for the infringement if, when the person supplied the copy, he or she knew, or had reason to believe, that the copy he or she supplied, or a copy made directly or indirectly from the copy, was likely to be so used as to infringe copyright.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 26 (UK)
The provisions of this Part are to be construed independently of one another so that the fact that an act is not permitted by one provision does not mean that it is not permitted by another provision.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 28(4) (UK)
(1)Copyright in a work is not infringed by—
(2)For the purposes of subsection (1), a musical work, words spoken or sung with music, or so much of a sound recording or communication work as includes a musical work or those words, must not be regarded as incidentally copied in another work if the musical work or the words, sound recording, or communication work is deliberately copied.
Section 41: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 21 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)Fair dealing with a work for the purposes of criticism or review, of that or another work or of a performance of a work, does not infringe copyright in the work if such fair dealing is accompanied by a sufficient acknowledgement.
(2)Fair dealing with a work for the purpose of reporting current events by means of a sound recording, film, or communication work does not infringe copyright in the work.
(3)Fair dealing with a work (other than a photograph) for the purposes of reporting current events by any means other than those referred to in subsection (2) does not infringe copyright in the work if such fair dealing is accompanied by a sufficient acknowledgement.
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 19(2), (3), 20(2), (3); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 30 (UK)
Section 42(2): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 22 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)Fair dealing with a work for the purposes of research or private study does not infringe copyright in the work.
(2)For the avoidance of doubt, it is hereby declared that fair dealing with a published edition for the purposes of research or private study does not infringe copyright in either the typographical arrangement of the edition or any literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work or part of a work in the edition.
(3)In determining, for the purposes of subsection (1), whether copying, by means of a reprographic process or by any other means, constitutes fair dealing for the purposes of research or private study, a court shall have regard to—
(4)This section does not authorise the making of more than 1 copy of the same work, or the same part of a work, on any one occasion, but in this subsection copy does not include a non-infringing transient reproduction to which section 43A applies.
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 19(1), (5), 20(1); Copyright Act 1968 s 40(1), (2) (Aust); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 29(1), (2) (UK)
Section 43(4): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 23 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
A reproduction of a work does not infringe copyright in the work if the reproduction—
Section 43A: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 24 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)Copyright in a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work or the typographical arrangement of a published edition is not infringed by the copying of the whole or part of the work or edition if—
(2)Copyright in a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work or the typographical arrangement of a published edition is not infringed by the copying of the whole or part of the work or edition if—
(3)Copyright in a literary, dramatic, or musical work or the typographical arrangement of a published edition is not infringed by the copying of part of the work or edition if—
(4)If the effect of subparagraph (i) or subparagraph (ii) of subsection (3)(f) would be that the whole of a work or edition is copied, those subparagraphs shall not apply and the copying that is permitted under subsection (3) shall be of no more than 50% of the whole work or edition.
(4A)A copy of a work made in accordance with subsections (3) and (4) may be communicated to a person who is a student or other person who is to receive, is receiving, or has received, a lesson that relates to the work.
(5)Copyright in an artistic work is not infringed by the copying, by means of a reprographic process or by any other means, of the whole or a part of that work if the artistic work is included within the part of any work or edition copied under subsection (3).
(6)Where any part of a work or edition is copied under subsection (3) by or on behalf of an educational establishment,—
(7)In subsections (3) to (6),—
published edition or edition, in relation to a collective work, means that part of the edition containing each work or part of a work
work, in relation to a collective work, means each of the works or parts of works in the collective work.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 ss 32(1), 36(1) (UK)
Section 44(4A): inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 25 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)An educational establishment does not infringe copyright in a work that is made available on a website or other electronic retrieval system by storing a copy of the page or pages in which the work appears if—
(2)Subsection (1) does not apply, and the educational establishment does infringe copyright in the work, if the educational establishment knowingly fails to delete the stored material within a reasonable time after the material becomes no longer relevant to the course of instruction for which it was stored.
(3)In subsection (1), authenticated user means a person who—
Section 44A: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 26 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)Copyright in any work that is a film, sound recording, or communication work, or any work included in a film, sound recording, or communication work, is not infringed by the copying of that work in the circumstances set out in subsection (2).
(2)The circumstances referred to in subsection (1) are—
where the lesson is on how to make films or film soundtracks; and
(3)Copyright in—
is not infringed by the copying of that work in the circumstances set out in subsection (4).
(4)The circumstances referred to in subsection (3) are—
where the lesson—
(5)Subsections (3) and (4) do not apply if or to the extent that licences authorising the copying of a work in the circumstances set out in subsection (4) are available under a licensing scheme and the person doing the copying knew that fact.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 32(2) (UK)
Section 45(1): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 27 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The copying of a short passage from a published work (being a literary, dramatic, or musical work) in a collection that—
does not infringe copyright in the work if—
(2)Subsection (1) does not authorise the copying of more than 2 passages from copyright works by the same author in collections published by the same publisher over any period of 5 years.
(3)In relation to any given passage, the reference in subsection (2) to passages from copyright works by the same author—
(4)References in this section to the use of a work in an educational establishment are to any use for the educational purposes of such an establishment.
(5)Subsection (1) does not apply to a literary work that is a computer program.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 19(6); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 33 (UK)
(1)The performance of a literary, dramatic, or musical work before an audience consisting of persons who are students or staff members at an educational establishment or are directly connected with the activities of the establishment—
is not a performance in public for the purposes of section 32(1).
(2)The playing or showing, for the purposes of instruction, of a sound recording, film, or communication work to the audience described in subsection (1) at an educational establishment is not a playing or showing of the work in public for the purposes of section 32(2).
(3)For the purposes of this section, a person shall not be treated as a person directly connected with the activities of an educational establishment by reason only that the person is a parent or guardian of a student at that educational establishment.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 21(5); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 34 (UK)
Section 47(2): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 28 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)This section applies when a copy of a communication work is—
(2)In any case to which subsection (1)(a) applies, the making or communication of a copy of the communication work by or on behalf of an educational establishment, and the subsequent communication of the copy within the educational establishment, does not infringe copyright in the communication work or in any work included in it if the copy is made or communicated for the educational establishment’s educational purposes.
(3)In any case to which subsection (1)(b) applies, the making and supply of a copy of the communication work by an educational resource supplier does not infringe copyright in the communication work or in any work included in it if the copy is made and supplied for the educational purposes of the educational establishment to which it is supplied.
(4)However, the exclusions from infringement of copyright in subsections (2) and (3) do not apply to—
Section 48: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 29 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Copyright is not infringed by anything done for the purposes of an examination, whether by way of setting the questions, communicating the questions to the candidates, or answering the questions.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 21(4)(b); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 32(3) (UK)
(1)In sections 51 to 56C, unless the context otherwise requires,—
archive—
prescribed library means—
(2)In sections 51 to 56C, every reference to the librarian of a prescribed library or the archivist of an archive shall be read as including a person acting on behalf of the librarian or archivist.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 37(6) (UK)
Section 50(1): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 30 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 50(1) archive paragraph (a)(i): substituted, on 21 April 2005, by section 67(1) of the Public Records Act 2005 (2005 No 40).
Section 50(1) archive paragraph (b): substituted, on 21 April 2005, by section 67(1) of the Public Records Act 2005 (2005 No 40).
Section 50(1) prescribed library paragraph (c): substituted, on 1 August 2008, by section 348 of the Lawyers and Conveyancers Act 2006 (2006 No 1).
Section 50(1) prescribed library paragraph (c): amended, on 7 July 2010, by section 4 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2010 (2010 No 55).
Section 50(2): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 30 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The librarian of a prescribed library may, if the conditions contained in subsection (2) are complied with, make from a published edition (other than a published edition that is an article in a periodical), for supply to any person, a copy of a reasonable proportion of any literary, dramatic, or musical work, and may include in the copy any artistic work that appears within the proportion copied, without infringing copyright in the literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work or the typographical arrangement of the published edition.
(2)The conditions referred to in subsection (1) are—
(3)Where any person is supplied with, or otherwise comes into possession of, a copy made in accordance with this section, that person may use the copy only for the purposes of research or private study.
(4)This section does not apply to a literary work that is a computer program.
(5)In this section, copy includes a digital copy, but in that case section 56B applies as well.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 21(1); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 39 (UK)
Section 51(5): added, on 31 October 2008, by section 31 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The librarian of a prescribed library may, if the conditions contained in subsection (2) are complied with, make for supply to any person a copy of—
without infringing copyright in the literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work or the typographical arrangement of the published edition.
(2)The conditions referred to in subsection (1) are—
(3)Where any person is supplied with, or otherwise comes into possession of, a copy made in accordance with this section, that person may use the copy only for the purposes of research or private study.
(4)In this section, copy includes a digital copy, but in that case section 56B applies as well.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 21(1); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 38 (UK)
Section 52(4): added, on 31 October 2008, by section 32 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The librarian of a prescribed library may, if the condition contained in subsection (2) is complied with, make from a published edition, for supply to another prescribed library, a copy of,—
without infringing copyright in the literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work or the typographical arrangement of the published edition.
(2)The condition referred to in subsection (1) is that a person has requested the library to which the copy is being supplied to supply him or her with the copy for the purposes of research or private study.
(3)Where any person is supplied with, or otherwise comes into possession of, a copy made in accordance with this section, that person may use the copy only for the purposes of research or private study.
(4)This section does not apply to a literary work that is a computer program.
(5)In this section, copy includes a digital copy, but in that case section 56C applies as well.
Section 53(5): added, on 31 October 2008, by section 33 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The librarian of a prescribed library may, if the conditions contained in subsection (2) are complied with, make a copy of a literary, dramatic, or musical work and any artistic work included in the work, where the copy is—
without infringing copyright in the literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work or the typographical arrangement of the published edition.
(2)The conditions referred to in subsection (1) are that the librarian to whom the copy of the work is supplied—
(3)In subsection (2)(d), the term equitable remuneration means a sum agreed by the librarian and the copyright owner or, in the absence of agreement, a sum determined by the Tribunal on an application under section 168.
(4)This section does not apply to a literary work that is a computer program.
(5)In this section, copy includes a digital copy, but in that case section 56C applies as well.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 21(2); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 41 (UK)
Section 54(5): added, on 31 October 2008, by section 34 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The librarian of a prescribed library or the archivist of an archive may make a copy (other than a digital copy) of any item in the collection of the library or archive for the purposes of—
without infringing copyright in any work included in the item.
(2)Subsection (1) applies only where it is not reasonably practicable to purchase a copy of the item in question to fulfil the purpose.
(3)The librarian of a prescribed library or the archivist of an archive may make a digital copy of any item (the original item) in the collection of the library or archive without infringing copyright in any work included in the item if—
(4)The librarian of a prescribed library or the archivist of an archive may make a digital copy of any item (the original item) in the collection of the library or archive without infringing copyright in any work included in the item if—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 42 (UK)
Section 55(1): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 35(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 55(3): added, on 31 October 2008, by section 35(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 55(4): added, on 31 October 2008, by section 35(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The librarian of a prescribed library or the archivist of an archive may, if the conditions contained in subsection (3) are complied with, copy for supply to any person a copy of an unpublished work in the library or archive, without infringing copyright in that work.
(2)This section does not apply if the copyright owner has prohibited copying of the work and at the time the copy is made the librarian or archivist making it is, or ought to be, aware of that fact.
(3)The conditions referred to in subsection (1) are—
(4)Where any person is supplied with, or otherwise comes into possession of, a copy made in accordance with this section, that person may use the copy only for the purposes of research or private study.
(5)The provisions of this section do not apply to the sound archive maintained by Radio New Zealand Limited, the film archive maintained by Television New Zealand Limited, or the film archive maintained by the New Zealand Film Archive Incorporated.
(6)In this section, copy includes a digital copy, but in that case section 56B applies as well.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 21(3); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 43 (UK)
Section 56(6): added, on 31 October 2008, by section 36 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The librarian of a prescribed library or the archivist of an archive does not infringe copyright in a work by communicating a digital copy of the work to an authenticated user if the following conditions are met:
(2)In subsection (1), authenticated user means a person who—
Section 56A: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 37 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
A copy of a work to which section 51, 52, or 56 applies must not be supplied in a digital format, by the librarian of a prescribed library or the archivist of an archive, to a person (A) unless the following conditions are also complied with:
Section 56B: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 37 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
A copy of a work to which section 53 or 54 applies must not be supplied in a digital format to a library unless the librarian supplying the digital copy destroys, as soon as is reasonably practicable, any additional copy made in the process of making the copy that is supplied.
Section 56C: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 37 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The sound archive maintained by Radio New Zealand Limited may play a sound recording held in the archive to an audience consisting of members of the public, without infringing copyright in the sound recording or in any work included in the sound recording, if the condition contained in subsection (3) is complied with.
(2)The film archive maintained by Television New Zealand Limited or by the New Zealand Film Archive Incorporated may show a film, and play any sound recording associated with the film, held in the archive to an audience consisting of members of the public, without infringing copyright in the film or in any sound recording associated with the film or in any work included in the film or sound recording, if the condition contained in subsection (3) is complied with.
(3)The condition referred to in subsections (1) and (2) is that, where any person is required to pay to—
the payment required is no more than a reasonable contribution towards the maintenance of the archive in which the sound recording or film is held.
(4)This section does not apply if or to the extent that licences authorising the playing of a sound recording, or the showing of a film and the playing of a sound recording associated with the film, by an archive to which this section applies are available and if the archive knew that fact.
(1)The communication of an archived work in accordance with section 29C of the Television New Zealand Act 2003 does not infringe copyright (if any) in the archived work under this Act.
(2)In this section, archived work has the same meaning as in section 29A of the Television New Zealand Act 2003.
Section 57A: inserted, on 23 July 2011, by section 14 of the Television New Zealand Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 52).
(1)An officer of the Parliamentary Library may, if the conditions contained in subsection (3) are complied with, supply to any member of Parliament a copy of a literary or dramatic work, and any artistic work included in that work, without infringing copyright in that literary, dramatic, or artistic work or the typographical arrangement of a published edition.
(2)An officer of the Parliamentary Library may, if the conditions contained in subsection (3) are complied with, supply to any member of Parliament a recording of a communication work or a transcript of a recording of the communication work, without infringing copyright in the communication work or any work included in that communication work.
(3)The conditions referred to in subsections (1) and (2) are—
Section 58(2): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 38 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)Copyright is not infringed by anything done for the purposes of parliamentary or judicial proceedings.
(2)Copyright is not infringed by anything done for the purposes of reporting parliamentary or judicial proceedings.
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 19(4), 20(7); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 45 (UK)
(1)Copyright is not infringed by anything done for the purposes of the proceedings of a Royal commission, commission of inquiry, ministerial inquiry, or statutory inquiry.
(2)Copyright is not infringed by anything done for the purposes of reporting any proceedings of a Royal commission, commission of inquiry, ministerial inquiry, or statutory inquiry that are held in public.
(3)Copyright in a work is not infringed by the issue to the public of copies of the report of a Royal commission, commission of inquiry, ministerial inquiry, or statutory inquiry containing the work or material from it.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 46 (UK)
(1)Subject to any Order in Council made under subsection (4), where material is open to public inspection or public reference pursuant to a statutory requirement, or is on a statutory register, copyright in the material is not infringed by the copying of the material, by or with the authority of the appropriate person, for a purpose that does not involve the issuing of copies to the public.
(2)Subject to any Order in Council made under subsection (4), where material is open to public inspection or public reference pursuant to a statutory requirement, copyright is not infringed by the copying or issuing to the public of copies of the material, by or with the authority of the appropriate person, for the purpose of enabling the material to be inspected at a more convenient time or place or otherwise facilitating the exercise of any right for the purpose of which the requirement is imposed.
(3)Subject to any Order in Council made under subsection (4), where material that is open to public inspection or public reference pursuant to a statutory requirement, or that is on a statutory register, contains information about matters of general scientific, technical, commercial, or economic interest, copyright is not infringed by the copying or issuing to the public of copies of the material, by or with the authority of the appropriate person, for the purpose of disseminating that information.
(4)The Governor-General may from time to time, by Order in Council, provide that all or any of subsections (1) to (3) shall, in such cases as may be specified in the order, apply only to copies marked in such manner as may be so specified.
(5)The Governor-General may from time to time, by Order in Council, provide that all or any of subsections (1) to (3) apply, to such extent and with such modifications as may be specified in the order, in relation to—
as those provisions apply in relation to material open to public inspection or public reference pursuant to a statutory requirement or by virtue of being on a statutory register.
(6)In this section,—
appropriate person means the person required to make the material open to public inspection or public reference or, as the case may be, the person maintaining the register
statutory register means a register maintained pursuant to a statutory requirement
statutory requirement means a requirement imposed by a provision of an enactment.
(7)An order under this section is secondary legislation (see Part 3 of the Legislation Act 2019 for publication requirements).
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 61; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 ss 47, 49 (UK)
| Legislation Act 2019 requirements for secondary legislation made under this section | ||
| Publication | PCO must publish it on the legislation website and notify it in the Gazette | LA19 s 69(1)(c) |
| Presentation | The Minister must present it to the House of Representatives | LA19s 114, Sch 1 cl 32(1)(a) |
| Disallowance | It may be disallowed by the House of Representatives | LA19 ss 115, 116 |
| This note is not part of the Act. | ||
Section 61(7): inserted, on 28 October 2021, by section 3 of the Secondary Legislation Act 2021 (2021 No 7).
(1)This section applies where—
(2)The Crown may, for—
copy the work, and issue copies of the work to the public, without infringing copyright in the work.
(3)The Crown may not copy a work, or issue copies of a work to the public, under this section if the work has previously been published otherwise than under this section.
(4)In subsection (1), the term public business includes any activity carried on by the Crown.
(5)This section has effect subject to any agreement to the contrary between the Crown and the copyright owner.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 48 (UK)
(1)Copyright in a work is not infringed by anything done in relation to the work, by or on behalf of the Crown or any person authorised in writing by a government department,—
(2)Where any act is done under subsection (1), the Crown shall be liable to pay, out of money appropriated by Parliament for the purpose, equitable remuneration to the copyright owner upon such terms as may be agreed upon between the Crown and the copyright owner or, in the absence of agreement, upon such terms as shall be determined by the Tribunal.
(3)No act to which subsection (1) applies shall—
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 53(1), (3), (4)
(1)No provision of any assignment or licence in force between the copyright owner and a person other than a government department shall be effective to prevent any act being done in relation to a copyright work, where that act is done under section 63.
(2)Where—
the Crown shall be liable to pay, out of money appropriated by Parliament for the purpose, equitable remuneration to the licensee upon such terms as may be agreed between the Crown and the licensee or, in the absence of agreement, upon such terms as shall be determined by the Tribunal.
(3)Where—
the person is entitled to recover from the owner or exclusive licensee, as the case may be, such part of any payment as may be agreed between that person and the copyright owner or the exclusive licensee, as the case may be, or, in the absence of agreement, as shall be determined by the Tribunal.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 54
(1)Where any employee or agent of the Crown infringes copyright in a work, and the infringement is committed with the authority of the Crown, civil proceedings in respect of the infringement shall, subject to this Act, lie against the Crown under the Crown Proceedings Act 1950.
(2)Nothing in subsection (1) shall affect the rights of the Crown, or any person authorised by a government department, under section 63.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 55(1), (2)
(1)Where the doing of a particular act is specifically authorised by an enactment, the doing of that act does not infringe copyright, unless the enactment provides otherwise.
(2)Nothing in this section shall be construed as excluding any defence of statutory authority otherwise available under or pursuant to any enactment.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 50 (UK)
(1)Copyright in a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work is not infringed by any act done at a time when, or in pursuance of arrangements made at a time when,—
(2)Subsection (1)(b)(ii) does not apply in relation to—
(3)In relation to a work of joint authorship,—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 57 (UK)
(1)Where a recording of spoken words is made, in writing or otherwise, for the purpose of—
it is not an infringement of copyright in the words as a literary work to use the recording or material taken from it (or to copy the recording, or any such material, and use the copy) for that purpose, if the conditions in subsection (2) are complied with.
(2)The conditions referred to in subsection (1) are that—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 58 (UK)
Section 68(1)(b): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 39(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 68(2)(a): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 39(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)An entity that is 1 or more of the following may undertake the activities set out in section 69A:
(2)Before beginning activities under section 69A for the first time, an authorised entity must give notice to the Ministry that it intends to do so.
Section 69: replaced, on 4 January 2020, by section 5 of the Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43).
(1)An authorised entity does not infringe copyright in the relevant work if the entity acts in accordance with this section.
(2)An authorised entity may make an accessible format copy if the entity—
(3)An authorised entity (A) may import into New Zealand an accessible format copy from an authorised entity (B) in another Marrakesh Treaty country if A—
(4)An authorised entity may do 1 or more of the following:
Section 69A: inserted, on 4 January 2020, by section 5 of the Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43).
(1)A person who is not an authorised entity does not infringe copyright in the relevant work if he or she—
(2)The person may do 1 or more of the following:
Section 69B: inserted, on 4 January 2020, by section 5 of the Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43).
(1)An authorised entity must—
(2)An authorised entity may charge a fee for providing an accessible format copy to a person, but the fee must not be higher than the sum of the cost to the entity of making, providing, reproducing, importing, or exporting the copy (as applicable) and a reasonable contribution to the general expenses of the entity.
Section 69C: inserted, on 4 January 2020, by section 5 of the Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43).
The Ministry must publish on its Internet site a list of authorised entities that have given notice under section 69(2).
Section 69D: inserted, on 4 January 2020, by section 5 of the Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43).
(1)The reading in public or recitation in public by 1 person of a reasonable extract from a published literary or dramatic work shall not be treated as a performance in public for the purposes of section 32(1), if that reading or recitation is accompanied by a sufficient acknowledgement.
(2)Copyright in a work is not infringed by the making of a sound recording, or the communication to the public, of a reading or recitation that under subsection (1) is not treated as a performance in public, if the recording or communication work consists mainly of material in relation to which it is not necessary to rely on that subsection.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 19(8); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 59 (UK)
Section 70(2): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 41 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Where an article on a scientific or technical subject is published in a periodical accompanied by an abstract indicating the contents of the article, it is not an infringement of copyright in the abstract, or in the article, to copy the abstract or issue copies of the abstract to the public.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 60(1) (UK)
(1)A sound recording of a performance of a song may be made for the purpose of including the song in an archive maintained by a body prescribed by regulations made under this Act, without infringing copyright in the words as a literary work or in the accompanying musical work, if the conditions in subsection (2) are complied with.
(2)The conditions referred to in subsection (1) are that—
(3)Copies of a sound recording made in reliance on subsection (1) and included in an archive maintained by a body prescribed by regulations made under this Act may, if the condition contained in subsection (4) is complied with, be made and supplied by the archivist without infringing copyright in the recording or the works included in it.
(4)The condition referred to in subsection (3) is that no person is furnished with more than 1 copy of the same recording.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 61 (UK)
(1)This section applies to the following works:
(2)Copyright in a work to which this section applies is not infringed by—
(3)Copyright is not infringed by the issue to the public of copies, or the communication to the public, of anything the making of which was, under this section, not an infringement of copyright.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 62 (UK)
Section 73(2)(c): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 42(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 73(3): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 42(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The making of any object in 3 dimensions (including, subject to subsection (2), a copy in 2 dimensions reasonably required for the making of the object) does not infringe copyright in a literary or artistic work, if the work or a copy of it forms part of—
(2)Subsection (1) does not authorise—
where the copy is made directly from that artistic work; or
(3)If a patent that has ceased to have effect is restored by an order made under subpart 12 of Part 3 of the Patents Act 2013, nothing done under subsection (1) in the period beginning with the day on which the patent ceased to have effect and ending with the close of the day on which the order is made constitutes an infringement of copyright in any literary or artistic work or copy of the work forming part of the patent specification.
(4)If the registered protection in New Zealand of a design that has ceased to have effect is restored by an order made under section 41A of the Designs Act 1953, nothing done under subsection (1) in the period beginning with the day on which the protection ceased to have effect and ending with the close of the day on which the order is made constitutes an infringement of copyright in any literary or artistic work or copy of the work forming part of the design.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 20A; 1985 No 134 s 4
Section 74(1): replaced, on 13 September 2014, by section 249 of the Patents Act 2013 (2013 No 68).
Section 74(3): replaced, on 13 September 2014, by section 249 of the Patents Act 2013 (2013 No 68).
Section 74(4): added, on 19 April 2011, by section 8 of the Designs Amendment Act 2010 (2010 No 15).
(1)The making of—
does not infringe copyright in an artistic work if, when the object or copy is made, the artistic work has been applied industrially, in New Zealand or in any other country, by or with the licence of the copyright owner,—
(2)Subsection (1) does not apply to—
(3)Subsection (1) does not authorise the making of a copy in 2 dimensions of an artistic work that is in 2 dimensions, where the copy is made directly from that artistic work.
(4)For the purposes of subsection (1), an artistic work is applied industrially if—
(5)For the purposes of subsection (4), 2 or more copies in 3 dimensions that are of the same general character and intended for use together are a single copy.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 20B; 1985 No 134 s 5
(1)The copying or adaptation or publication of a literary work or an artistic work does not infringe copyright in that work if that work—
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 20C; 1990 No 71 s 5
Where the author of an artistic work is not the copyright owner, he or she does not infringe copyright in that work by copying the work in making another artistic work, if the main design of the earlier work is not repeated or imitated.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 20(9); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 64 (UK)
Anything done for the purposes of reconstructing a building does not infringe copyright—
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 20(10); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 65 (UK)
Copyright in a work (being a computer program, sound recording, or film) is not infringed by the rental of that work to any person by an educational establishment or a prescribed library within the meaning of section 50, where—
(1)Subject to subsection (3), copyright in a computer program is not infringed by the making of a copy of the computer program if—
(2)If the original copy is lost, destroyed, or rendered unusable, the copy made pursuant to subsection (1) shall be deemed for the purposes of this section to be the original copy.
(3)Subsection (1) does not apply to the making of a copy of a computer program—
(4)For the purposes of this section,—
Compare: Copyright Act 1968 s 43A (Aust)
(1)The lawful user of a copy of a computer program expressed in a low level language does not infringe copyright in the program by decompiling it, if the conditions in subsection (2) are met.
(2)The conditions referred to in subsection (1) are that—
(3)In particular, the conditions in subsection (2) are not met if—
(4)In this section, decompile means—
Section 80A: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 43 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The lawful user of a computer program (A) does not infringe copyright in it by copying or adapting it, if—
(2)This section does not apply to copying or adapting that is permitted under section 80A or 80C.
Section 80B: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 43 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
The lawful user of a computer program (A) does not infringe copyright in it by observing, studying, or testing the functioning of the program in order to determine the ideas and principles that underlie any element of the program if A does so while performing the acts of loading, displaying, running, transmitting, or storing the program that A is entitled to do.
Section 80C: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 43 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
A term or condition in an agreement for the use of a computer program has no effect in so far as it prohibits or restricts any activity undertaken in accordance with section 80A(2) or 80B(1).
Section 80D: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 43 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)It is not an infringement of copyright in a sound recording to play the sound recording as part of the activities of, or for the benefit of, a club, society, or other organisation, if the conditions contained in subsection (2) are complied with.
(2)The conditions referred to in subsection (1) are—
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 13(6); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 67 (UK)
(1)Copyright in a sound recording and in a literary or musical work contained in it is not infringed by copying the sound recording, if the following conditions are met:
(2)For the avoidance of doubt, subsection (1) does not apply if the owner of the sound recording is bound by a contract that specifies the circumstances in which the sound recording may be copied.
Section 81A: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 44 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Heading: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 45 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
The author of a communication work does not infringe copyright in it, or in any work included in it, by recording it, if the recording is made and used solely for the purpose of checking on the maintenance of standards in communication works made by the author.
Section 82: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 45 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)A person (A) does not infringe copyright in a communication work, or in any work included in it, by recording it or communicating it or both to a complaint authority, if the recording or the communication or both are done solely for the purpose of complaining to a complaint authority.
(2)However, subsection (1) does not apply, and A does infringe copyright in the communication work recorded and in any work included in the recording, if A retains the recording for any longer than is reasonably necessary to prepare and despatch the complaint.
(3)If a person infringes copyright under subsection (2), the recording is treated as an infringing copy.
(4)In this section and in section 84, complaint authority means any person or body that is responsible for dealing with complaints about the content of communication works, including the content of advertisements in communication works.
Section 83: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 45 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)A person (A) does not infringe copyright in a programme included in a communication work, or in any work included in it, by recording it, if—
(2)However, subsection (1) does not apply, and A does infringe copyright in the communication work recorded and in any work included in the communication work, if—
(3)If a person infringes copyright under subsection (2), the recording is treated as an infringing copy.
________________________________________________________________________________________________
Example
A records a movie to be screened on television because she will be at work when it screens. She watches the movie on the weekend and then later tapes over it. Provided the conditions in s 84(1) are met, the copy that A makes is not an infringing copy.
B copies music from a streamed Internet audio service and keeps the copy as part of B’s music collection, in order to listen to it multiple times on demand. Copies made for the home library or collection in this way are infringing copies.
________________________________________________________________________________________________
Section 84: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 45 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)This section applies where, under an assignment or a licence, a person is authorised to communicate the following works to the public:
(2)Where this section applies, the person so authorised may, without the consent of the copyright owner but only if the conditions contained in subsection (3) are complied with, do or authorise the doing of any of the following acts for the purposes of the communication work:
(3)The conditions referred to in subsection (2) are—
(4)A recording, film, photograph, or copy made in accordance with this section shall be treated as an infringing copy—
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 19(9), (10); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 68 (UK)
Section 85 heading: amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 46(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 85(1): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 46(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 85(2): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 46(3) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 85(3)(b): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 46(4) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 85(3)(b): amended, on 21 April 2005, by section 67(1) of the Public Records Act 2005 (2005 No 40).
[Repealed]
Section 86: repealed, on 31 October 2008, by section 47 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The free public playing or showing of a communication work (other than a communication work to which section 87A applies) does not infringe any copyright in—
(2)For the purposes of this section, the public playing or showing of a communication work is not free if—
(3)For the purposes of subsection (2)(a), the following persons must not be treated as having paid for admission to the venue:
Section 87: substituted, on 16 September 2011, by section 5(1) of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)This section applies to the playing or showing of a communication work that—
(2)The free public playing or showing of a communication work to which this section applies does not infringe any copyright in—
(3)For the purposes of this section, the public playing or showing of a communication work is not free if—
(4)For the purposes of subsection (3)(a), the following persons must not be treated as having paid for admission to the venue:
Section 87A: inserted, on 16 September 2011, by section 5(1) of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Where the making of a communication work is an infringement of copyright, the fact that the work was heard or seen in public by the reception of the communication work must be taken into account in assessing the damages for the infringement.
Section 87B: inserted, on 16 September 2011, by section 5(1) of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)This section applies where a broadcast made from a place in New Zealand is, by reception and immediate retransmission, included in a cable programme service.
(2)Where this section applies,—
(3)This section does not apply if or to the extent that licences authorising the reception and immediate retransmission of a broadcast and any work included in the broadcast are available to the person providing the cable programme service under a licensing scheme and the person providing the cable programme service knew that fact.
(4)For the purposes of this section only,—
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 60; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 73 (UK)
Section 88(4): added, on 31 October 2008, by section 49 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)A body prescribed by regulation made under this Act may, for the purpose of providing people who are deaf or hard of hearing, or physically or mentally disabled in any other way, with copies that are subtitled or otherwise modified for their special needs, make copies of a communication work and issue copies to the public, without infringing any copyright in the communication work or in any work included in the communication work.
(2)A body must not be prescribed for the purposes of subsection (1) if it is established or conducted for profit.
Section 89: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 50 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)A person (A) does not infringe copyright in a communication work, or in any work included in it, by recording it or making a copy of a recording of it, if—
(2)A body shall not be prescribed for the purposes of subsection (1) if it is established or conducted for profit.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 75 (UK)
Section 90(1): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 51 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)This section applies to a recording, or a transcript of a recording, of a communication work that consists wholly or substantially of news or reports or discussions of current events.
(1A)The person who makes the recording or transcript does not infringe copyright in the communication work, or in any work included in the communication work, if the conditions in subsection (2) are complied with.
(2)The conditions referred to in subsection (1A) are—
(3)In subsection (2)(d), the term equitable remuneration means a sum agreed by the person who makes the recording and the copyright owner or, in the absence of agreement, a sum determined by the Tribunal on an application under section 168.
(4)This section does not apply if or to the extent that licences authorising the recording of the communication work and the making of transcripts of the recordings are available under a licensing scheme and the person making the recording knew that fact.
Section 91(1): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 52(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 91(1A): inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 52(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 91(2): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 52(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 91(4): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 52(3) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
An act that under this Act may be done without infringing copyright in a literary, dramatic, or musical work does not, where that work is an adaptation, infringe any copyright in the work from which the adaptation was made.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 76 (UK)
Heading: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 53 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
[Repealed]
Section 92A: repealed (without coming into force), on 1 September 2011, by section 4 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
(1)This section applies if a person (A) infringes the copyright in a work by using 1 or more of the Internet services of an Internet service provider to do a restricted act without the consent of the copyright owner.
(2)Merely because A uses the Internet services of the Internet service provider in infringing the copyright, the Internet service provider, without more,—
(2A)An Internet service provider does not infringe the copyright in the work, or authorise A’s infringement of the copyright in the work, merely because the Internet service provider knows of the infringement from information received as a result of anything done under sections 122A to 122U, provided that, in relation to the alleged infringement, the Internet service provider complies with all its obligations under those sections and under any regulations made under section 234(eb) to (eh).
(3)However, nothing in this section limits the right of the copyright owner to injunctive relief in relation to A’s infringement or any infringement by the Internet service provider.
(4)In subsections (1) and (2), Internet services means the services referred to in the definition of Internet service provider in section 2(1).
Section 92B: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 53 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 92B(2A): inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 5 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
(1)This section applies if—
(2)The Internet service provider does not infringe copyright in the work by storing the material unless—
(3)A court, in determining whether, for the purposes of subsection (2), an Internet service provider knows or has reason to believe that material infringes copyright in a work, must take account of all relevant matters, including whether the Internet service provider has received a notice of infringement in relation to the infringement.
(4)An Internet service provider who deletes a user’s material or prevents access to it because the Internet service provider knows or has reason to believe that it infringes copyright in a work must, as soon as possible, give notice to the user that the material has been deleted or access to it prevented.
(5)Nothing in this section limits the right of the copyright owner to injunctive relief in relation to a user’s infringement or any infringement by the Internet service provider.
Section 92C: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 53 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
A notice referred to in section 92C(3) must—
Section 92D: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 53 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)An Internet service provider does not infringe copyright in a work by caching material if the Internet service provider—
(2)However, an Internet service provider does infringe copyright in a work by caching material if the Internet service provider does not delete the material or prevent access to it by users as soon as possible after the Internet service provider became aware that—
(3)Nothing in this section limits the right of the copyright owner to injunctive relief in relation to a user’s infringement or any infringement by the Internet service provider.
(4)In this section,—
cache means the storage of material by an Internet service provider that is—
original source means the source from which the Internet service provider copied the material that is cached.
Section 92E: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 53 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)Where a copy that would otherwise be an infringing copy—
it shall be treated as an infringing copy—
(2)The provisions referred to in subsection (1) are as follows:
(3)In subsection (1), the term dealt with means—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 ss 32(5), 35(3), 36(5) (UK)
Section 93(2): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 54 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 93(2)(n): replaced, on 4 January 2020, by section 6 of the Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43).
(1)Subject to section 97,—
in the circumstances described in this section, but the right is not infringed unless it has been asserted in accordance with section 96.
(2)The author of a literary work (other than words intended to be sung or spoken with music) or a dramatic work has the right to be identified as the author of the work whenever—
(3)The author of—
from which an adaptation is made has the right to be identified as the author of the work from which the adaptation is made whenever any of the events described in subsection (2) occurs in relation to the adaptation of the work.
(4)The author of a musical work, or a literary work consisting of words intended to be sung or spoken with music, has the right to be identified as the author of the work whenever—
(5)The author of—
from which an adaptation is made has the right to be identified as the author of the work from which the adaptation is made whenever any of the events described in subsection (4) occurs in relation to the adaptation of the work.
(6)The author of an artistic work has the right to be identified as the author of the work whenever—
(7)The author of a work of architecture in the form of a building has the right to be identified as such on the building as constructed or, where more than 1 building is constructed to the design, on the first to be constructed.
(8)The director of a film has the right to be identified as the director of the film whenever—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 77(1)–(6), (9) (UK)
Section 94(2)(a): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 55(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 94(6)(b): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 55(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 94(8)(a): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 55(3) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The right conferred by section 94 on an author or director is as follows:
(2)For the purposes of subsection (1), if the author or director, in asserting his or her right to be identified, specifies a pseudonym, initials, or some other particular form of identification, that form shall be used, but, in any other case, any reasonable form of identification may be used.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 77(7), (8) (UK)
Section 95(1)(c): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 56 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)A person does not infringe the right conferred by section 94 by failing, in the circumstances described in that section, to identify the author as the author of the work or to identify the director as the director of the work, as the case may be, unless the right has been asserted under this section in such a way as to require that person to so identify the author or director.
(2)The right may be asserted generally, or in relation to any specified circumstances,—
(3)The right may be asserted in relation to the public exhibition of an artistic work—
(4)The persons bound by an assertion of the right under subsection (2) or subsection (3) are,—
(5)In an action for infringement of the right, the court shall, in considering remedies, take into account any delay in asserting the right.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 78 (UK)
(1)The right conferred by section 94 is subject to the exceptions set out in this section.
(2)The right does not apply in relation to—
(3)The right is not infringed by an act that, under any of the following provisions of this Act, would not infringe copyright in the work:
(4)The right does not apply in relation to any work made for the purpose of reporting current events.
(5)The right does not apply in relation to the publication, in—
of a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work made for the purposes of such publication or made available with the consent of the author for the purposes of such publication.
(6)The right does not apply to any act done by or with the licence of the copyright owner in relation to a work in which copyright first vested in the author’s employer under section 21(2) or in the director’s employer under section 5(2)(b), if—
(7)The right does not apply in relation to—
unless the author or director has previously been identified as such in or on published copies of the work.
(8)The right does not apply in relation to—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 79 (UK)
Section 97(3): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 57(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 97(8)(b): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 57(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)For the purposes of this section and section 99,—
and in the following provisions of this section any reference to a derogatory treatment of a work shall be construed accordingly.
(2)Subject to section 100 and 101,—
has the right not to have his or her work subjected to a derogatory treatment.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 80(1), (2), (8) (UK)
(1)In the case of a literary, dramatic, or musical work, the right conferred by section 98(2) is infringed by a person who—
a derogatory treatment of the work.
(2)In the case of an artistic work, the right conferred by section 98(2) is infringed by a person who—
issues to the public copies of a graphic work representing, or of a photograph of, a derogatory treatment of the work.
(3)Subsection (2) does not apply to a work of architecture in the form of a building; but where the author of such a work is identified on the building and it is the subject of derogatory treatment the author has the right to require the identification to be removed.
(4)In the case of a film, the right conferred by section 98(2) is infringed by a person who—
a derogatory treatment of the film soundtrack.
(5)The right conferred by section 98(2) extends to the treatment of parts of a work resulting from a previous treatment by a person other than the author or director of the work, if those parts are attributed to, or are likely to be regarded as the work of, the author or director.
(6)The right conferred by section 98(2) is infringed by a person who, in the course of a business,—
an object that is, and that the person knows or has reason to believe is, a work or a copy of a work that—
(7)The right conferred by section 98(2) is infringed by a person who does an act described in subsection (1) or subsection (2) or subsection (4) or subsection (6) or who authorises another person to do such an act.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 ss 80(3)–(7), 83 (UK)
Section 99(1)(a): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 58(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 99(2)(a): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 58(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 99(4)(a): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 58(3) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 99(4)(c)(i): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 58(4) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The right conferred by section 98(2) is, in relation to literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic works, subject to the exceptions set out in this section.
(2)The right does not apply to—
(3)The right does not apply in relation to the publication, in—
of a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work made for the purposes of such publication or made available with the consent of the author for the purposes of such publication.
(4)The right does not apply in relation to any subsequent exploitation elsewhere, without any modification of the published version, of a work to which subsection (3) applies.
(5)The right is not infringed by an act that, under section 67, would not infringe copyright.
(6)The right does not apply in relation to any work made for the purpose of reporting current events.
(7)The right is not infringed by any act done for the purpose of—
if,—
(8)The right does not apply to any act done, by or with the licence of the copyright owner, in relation to—
unless the author—
(9)Where the right applies under subsection (8), the right is not infringed if,—
(1)The right conferred by section 98(2) is, in relation to films, subject to the exceptions set out in this section.
(2)The right does not apply in relation to any film made for the purpose of reporting current events.
(3)The right is not infringed by any act done for the purpose of,—
if,—
(4)The right does not apply to any act done, by or with the licence of the copyright owner, in relation to—
unless the director—
(5)Where the right applies under subsection (4), the right is not infringed if,—
(6)The right is not infringed, in relation to the communication of a film to the public, if the person (A) communicating the film—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 ss 81, 82 (UK)
Section 101(3)(a): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 59(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 101(3)(b): repealed, on 31 October 2008, by section 59(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 101(6): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 59(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)In this section, the term attribution, in relation to a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work or a film, means an express or implied statement as to the identity of the author of the work or the director of the film.
(2)A person has the right—
(3)The right conferred by subsection (2) is infringed by a person who—
in or on which there is a false attribution; or
in or on which there is a false attribution,—
knowing, or having reason to believe, that the attribution is false.
(4)A person (A) infringes a right under subsection (2) if—
(5)The right conferred by subsection (2) is infringed by—
of material containing a false attribution in connection with any of the acts referred to in subsection (3) or subsection (4).
(6)The right conferred by subsection (2) is infringed by a person who, in the course of a business,—
in or on which there is a false attribution; or
in or on which there is a false attribution; or
knowing, or having reason to believe, that there is such an attribution and that the attribution is false.
(7)The right conferred by subsection (2) is infringed by a person who does an act described in this section or who authorises another person to do such an act.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 62(1), (2); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 84(1)–(5), (7) (UK)
Section 102(4): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 60 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)In this section, the term representation, in relation to a literary, dramatic, or musical work, means an express or implied statement as to the work being an adaptation of a work by a particular author.
(2)A person has the right not to have a literary, dramatic, or musical work falsely represented as being an adaptation of a work of which the person is the author.
(3)The right conferred by subsection (2) is infringed by a person who issues to the public copies of a literary, dramatic, or musical work in or on which there is a false representation, knowing or having reason to believe that the representation is false.
(4)A person (A) infringes the right conferred by subsection (2) if A performs in public, or communicates to the public, a literary, dramatic, or musical work, accompanied by a false representation, and A knows or has reason to believe that the representation is false.
(5)The right conferred by subsection (2) is infringed by—
of material containing a false representation in connection with any of the acts mentioned in subsection (3) or subsection (4).
(6)The right conferred by subsection (2) is infringed by a person who, in the course of a business,—
knowing, or having reason to believe, that there is such a representation and that the representation is false.
(7)The right conferred by subsection (2) is infringed by a person who does an act described in this section or who authorises another person to do such an act.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 62(3); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 84(8)(a) (UK)
Section 103(4): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 61 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)In this section, the term representation means an express or implied statement as to a matter referred to in paragraph (a) or paragraph (b) or paragraph (c) of subsection (2).
(2)The author of an artistic work has the right—
(3)The right conferred by subsection (2) is infringed by a person who exhibits in public an artistic work, or a copy of an artistic work, as the case may be, in or on which there is a false representation, knowing or having reason to believe that the representation is false.
(4)The right conferred by subsection (2) is infringed by—
of material containing a false representation in connection with any act referred to in subsection (3).
(5)The right conferred by subsection (2) is infringed by a person who, in the course of a business,—
knowing or having reason to believe there is such a representation and that the representation is false.
(6)The right conferred by subsection (2) is infringed by a person who does an act described in this section or who authorises another person to do such an act.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 62(4), (6); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 84(6), (8)(b) (UK)
(1)A person who, for private and domestic purposes, commissions the taking of a photograph or the making of a film has, where copyright exists in the resulting work but is owned by some other person, the right—
(2)Subject to subsection (3), the right conferred by subsection (1) is infringed by a person who does an act of the kind described in paragraph (a) or paragraph (b) or paragraph (c) of subsection (1).
(3)The right conferred by subsection (1) is not infringed by an act that, under any of the following provisions of this Act, would not infringe copyright in the work:
(4)The right conferred by subsection (1) is infringed by a person who does an act described in subsection (2) or who authorises another person to do such an act.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 85 (UK)
Section 105(1)(c): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 62(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 105(3)(a): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 62(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The rights conferred by the following provisions of this Act expire when the copyright in any work that is the subject of the right expires:
(2)The rights conferred by the following provisions of this Act expire at the end of the period of 20 years from the end of the calendar year in which the person who is entitled to the right dies:
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 62(5); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 86 (UK)
(1)It is not an infringement of any of the rights conferred by this Part to do any act to which the person who is entitled to the right has consented.
(2)Any of the rights conferred by this Part may be waived by instrument in writing signed by the person waiving the right.
(3)A waiver given pursuant to subsection (2)—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 87 (UK)
(1)This section does not apply to a film.
(2)A consent or waiver under section 107 by one joint author does not affect the rights of the other joint authors.
(3)The right conferred by section 94 is, in the case of a work of joint authorship, a right of each joint author to be identified as a joint author, and must be asserted in accordance with section 96 by each joint author in relation to himself or herself.
(4)The right conferred by section 98 is, in the case of a work of joint authorship, a right of each joint author.
(5)The right conferred by section 102 is infringed, in the circumstances described in that section,—
and such a false attribution infringes the right of every person to whom authorship of any description is, whether rightly or wrongly, attributed.
(6)The right conferred by section 103 is infringed, in the circumstances described in that section, by any false representation as to an adaptation of a work of joint authorship, and such a false representation infringes the right of each joint author.
(7)The right conferred by section 104 is infringed, in the circumstances described in that section, by any false representation as to a matter referred to in paragraph (a) or paragraph (b) or paragraph (c) of subsection (2) of that section, and such a false representation infringes the right of each joint author.
(8)The right conferred by section 105 is, in the case of a photograph made in pursuance of a joint commission, a right of each person who commissioned the taking of the photograph, so that—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 88(1)–(4), (6) (UK)
(1)Where a film was, or is alleged to have been, jointly directed,—
and such a false attribution infringes the right of every person to whom directorship of any description is, whether rightly or wrongly, attributed.
(2)For the purposes of subsection (1), a film is jointly directed if the film is made by the collaboration of 2 or more directors and the contribution of each director is not distinct from that of the other director or directors.
(3)The right conferred by section 105 is, in the case of a film made in pursuance of a joint commission, a right of each person who commissioned the making of the film, so that—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 88(5) (UK)
(1)The rights conferred by section 94 or section 105 apply in relation to the whole or any substantial part of a work.
(2)The rights conferred by the following provisions of this Act apply in relation to the whole or any part of a work:
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 89 (UK)
(1)A licence granted by a copyright owner is binding on every successor in title to that person’s interest in the copyright, except a purchaser in good faith for valuable consideration and without notice (actual or constructive) of the licence or a person deriving title from such a purchaser; and references in this Act to doing anything—
shall be construed accordingly.
(2)The licensee under an exclusive licence has the same rights against a successor in title who is bound by the licence as that licensee has against the copyright owner.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 56(4); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 ss 90(4), 92(2) (UK)
(1)This section applies to a licence that has been granted for—
(2)A warranty is implied in the licence that the person by whom or on whose behalf the licence is granted is—
Section 112: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 63 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)This section applies if—
(2)A court may award damages to compensate any of the following persons for any loss sustained because the event did not take place:
Section 112A: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 63 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
The provisions of sections 112 and 112A have effect no matter what any licence may say, and extend to all licences whether granted before or after the commencement of this Act.
Section 112B: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 63 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)Copyright is transmissible, as personal or moveable property, by—
(2)A transmission of copyright may be partial, that is, limited so as to apply—
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 56(1), (2); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 90(1), (2) (UK)
An assignment of copyright is not effective unless it is in writing signed by or on behalf of the assignor.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 56(3); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 90(3) (UK)
Where under a bequest (whether specific or general) a person is entitled, beneficially or otherwise, to—
the bequest shall, unless a contrary intention is indicated in the testator’s will or a codicil to that will, be construed as including the copyright in the work in so far as the testator was the copyright owner immediately before his or her death.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 59; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 93 (UK)
(1)Future copyright shall be capable of being assigned, wholly or partially, in the same manner and in all respects as if the copyright were then in existence, and on coming into existence the copyright shall vest in the assignee or the assignee’s successor in title accordingly.
(2)Sections 111(1), 113(2), and 114 apply to future copyright in the same manner as they apply to existing copyright.
(3)A licence granted by a person to whom future copyright has been assigned is binding on every successor in title to that person’s interest in the copyright, except a purchaser in good faith for valuable consideration and without notice (actual or constructive) of the licence or a person deriving title from such a purchaser; and references in this Act to doing anything—
shall be construed accordingly.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 57; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 91 (UK)
(1)This section applies where the owner of the copyright in an unpublished literary, dramatic, or musical work, or an unpublished artistic work other than a photograph, has, whether before or after the commencement of this Act, transferred or bequeathed to an institution—
subject to any conditions prohibiting, restricting, or regulating publication of the work for a specified period or without any limit on the period.
(2)While the manuscript, copy, or work is in the possession of the institution, any publication of the work in breach of such a condition by—
shall, notwithstanding that the copyright in the work may have expired, be actionable as if copyright continued to exist in the work and the publication were an infringement of the copyright.
(3)Nothing in this section applies to any publication with the consent of the person who would be the owner of the copyright in the work if the copyright had not expired.
(4)In this section, the term institution means the Crown, a local body, a prescribed library or archive within the meaning of section 50, an institution within the meaning of section 10(1) of the Education and Training Act 2020, or any other institution prescribed by regulations made under this Act.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 58
Section 117(4): amended, on 1 August 2020, by section 668 of the Education and Training Act 2020 (2020 No 38).
The rights conferred by Part 4 are not assignable.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 94 (UK)
(1)On the death of a person entitled to the right conferred by section 94 or section 98 or section 105,—
(2)Where—
the right shall pass in the same manner as the copyright.
(3)Where under paragraph (a) or paragraph (b) of subsection (1) a right becomes exercisable by more than 1 person,—
(4)A consent or waiver previously given or made binds any person to whom a right passes under subsection (1).
(5)Any infringement after a person’s death of the right conferred by section 102 or section 103 or section 104 is actionable by his or her personal representatives.
(6)Any damages recovered by personal representatives in respect of an infringement after the death of a person entitled to a right conferred by Part 4 shall devolve as part of the estate as if the right of action had existed and been vested in the person immediately before his or her death.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 95 (UK)
(1)An infringement of copyright is actionable by the copyright owner.
(2)In proceedings for infringement of copyright, all such relief by way of damages, injunctions, accounts, or otherwise is available to the plaintiff as is available in respect of the infringement of any other property right.
(3)This section has effect subject to the following provisions of this Part.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 24(1); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 96 (UK)
(1)Where, in proceedings for infringement of copyright, it is proved or admitted that at the time of the infringement the defendant did not know, and had no reason to believe, that copyright existed in the work to which the proceedings relate, the plaintiff is not entitled to damages but, without prejudice to the award of any other remedy, is entitled to an account of profits.
(2)In proceedings for infringement of copyright, the court may, having regard to all the circumstances and in particular to—
(3)In proceedings for infringement of copyright in respect of the construction of a building, no injunction or other order shall be made—
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 24(2)–(4); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 97 (UK)
(1)Where a person—
the owner of the copyright in the work may apply to the court for an order that the infringing copy or object be delivered up to the copyright owner or such other person as the court may direct.
(2)No order shall be made unless the court also makes, or it appears to the court that there are grounds for making, an order under section 134.
(3)A person to whom an infringing copy or other object is delivered up in pursuance of an order under this section shall, if an order under section 134 is not made, retain the copy or object pending the making of an order, or the decision not to make an order, under that section.
(4)Notwithstanding any rule of court, an order may be made pursuant to this section on an ex parte application by the copyright owner where service of notice of the application would cause undue delay or other serious detriment to the copyright owner.
(5)Nothing in this section affects any other power of the court.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 99 (UK)
Heading: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
(1)In this section and sections 122B to 122U, unless the context otherwise requires,—
account holder, in relation to an IPAP, means a person who has an account with the IPAP
detection notice means a detection notice issued by an IPAP to an account holder in respect of an alleged infringement against a rights owner (see section 122D)
enforcement notice means an enforcement notice issued by an IPAP to an account holder in respect of at least 3 alleged infringements against a rights owner (see section 122F)
file sharing is where—
infringement means an incidence of file sharing that involves the infringement of copyright in a work by a user
infringement notice means a detection notice, a warning notice, or an enforcement notice that—
IP address means an Internet protocol address
IPAP, or Internet protocol address provider, means a person that operates a business that, other than as an incidental feature of its main business activities,—
on-notice period means the period of 28 days beginning on the date of a detection notice or a warning notice
________________________________________________________________________________________________
Example
(1)A detection notice is issued on Monday, 1 March. The on-notice period ends with the close of Sunday, 28 March.
(2)A warning notice is issued on Friday, 16 April. The on-notice period ends with the close of Thursday, 6 May.
________________________________________________________________________________________________
quarantine period means a period of 35 days beginning on the date of an enforcement notice
________________________________________________________________________________________________
Example
(1)An enforcement notice is issued on Monday, 1 March. The quarantine period ends with the close of Sunday, 4 April.
(2)An enforcement notice is issued on Saturday, 18 December. The quarantine period ends with the close of Friday, 21 January.
________________________________________________________________________________________________
rights owner means—
warning notice means a warning notice issued by an IPAP to an account holder in respect of at least 2 alleged infringements against a rights owner (see section 122E).
(2)If a rights owner acts as agent for 1 or more copyright owners,—
(3)In this section and sections 122B to 122U, a reference to the date of an infringement, an infringement notice, a challenge, or a response to a challenge is a reference to,—
(4)Despite section 55 of the Legislation Act 2019, for the purposes of this section and sections 122B to 122U, periods of time end on the day calculated, whether or not that day is a working day.
(5)Examples used in this section and sections 122B to 122U are illustrative only. If an example is inconsistent with any provision, the provision prevails.
Section 122A: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 122A(4): amended, on 28 October 2021, by section 3 of the Secondary Legislation Act 2021 (2021 No 7).
(1)Sections 122A to 122U provide rights owners with a special regime for taking enforcement action against people who infringe copyright through file sharing.
(2)The regime provides that, at the instigation of rights owners, IPAPs must issue infringement notices to alleged infringers.
(3)The 3 kinds of infringement notices, in the order in which they are given, are a detection notice, a warning notice, and an enforcement notice.
(4)After an enforcement notice is issued to an alleged infringer, the rights owner may take enforcement action by seeking the following orders against the alleged infringer:
(5)Time limits apply to all stages of the regime.
(6)This section is by way of explanation only. If any provision is inconsistent with it, the other provision prevails.
Section 122B: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 122B(4)(b): amended, on 1 March 2017, by section 261 of the District Court Act 2016 (2016 No 49).
(1)If a rights owner provides an IPAP with information that identifies an IP address at which an infringement of its copyright is alleged to have occurred as a result of file sharing, the IPAP must—
________________________________________________________________________________________________
Example
An IPAP receives infringement information on Monday, 1 March. The IPAP must issue the infringement notice before the close of Monday, 8 March.
________________________________________________________________________________________________
(2)If information from a rights owner indicates that more than 1 infringement against the rights owner has occurred, any infringement notice sent to the account holder must identify the infringement that triggers that infringement notice, which must be the earliest recorded infringement for which the infringement notice could be issued.
(3)An IPAP need not comply with the obligation in subsection (1)(a) to match IP addresses if—
(4)An IPAP need not comply with the obligation in subsection (1)(b) to issue notices if—
(5)Notices issued to account holders must be sent by whatever method the IPAP uses to communicate with the account holder for billing purposes, unless the account holder and IPAP agree in writing to use a different method.
Section 122C: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
(1)An IPAP must issue a detection notice in relation to a rights owner to an account holder—
(2)A detection notice must be in the prescribed form (if a form is prescribed) and must—
(3)A detection notice expires 9 months after the date of the detection notice, unless the notice expires earlier under section 122F(4).
Section 122D: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
(1)An IPAP must issue a warning notice in relation to a rights owner to an account holder if—
________________________________________________________________________________________________
Example
A detection notice is issued on Monday, 1 March. It will expire with the close of Wednesday, 1 December. A warning notice can be issued on Monday, 29 March, and at any time up to and including Wednesday, 1 December.
________________________________________________________________________________________________
(2)A warning notice must be in the prescribed form (if a form is prescribed) and must—
(3)A warning notice expires 9 months after the date of the preceding detection notice, unless the notice expires earlier under section 122F(4).
Section 122E: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
(1)An IPAP must issue an enforcement notice in relation to a rights owner to an account holder if—
(2)An enforcement notice must be in the prescribed form (if a form is prescribed) and must—
(3)An enforcement notice expires at the end of a period of 35 days beginning on the date of the enforcement notice.
(4)On the date that an enforcement notice expires under subsection (3), the preceding detection notice and warning notice also expire.
(5)On issuing an enforcement notice to an account holder, the IPAP must send a, copy of the notice to the relevant rights owner, but must omit any information that discloses the name or contact details of the account holder.
Section 122F: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
(1)An account holder may challenge an infringement notice by sending a challenge, in the prescribed form, to the IPAP that issued the infringement notice.
(2)A challenge is not valid if it is received more than 14 days after the date of the infringement notice to which it relates.
(3)An IPAP that receives a valid challenge to an infringement notice must immediately forward it to the relevant rights owner.
________________________________________________________________________________________________
Example
A warning notice is issued on Monday, 1 March. A challenge sent before the close of Monday, 15 March is valid and must be forwarded to the rights owner. A challenge received on or after Tuesday, 16 March is not valid.
________________________________________________________________________________________________
(4)If the rights owner rejects the challenge,—
(5)If a challenge is rejected, it may be raised again by the account holder in any enforcement proceedings.
Section 122G: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
(1)A challenge is deemed to be accepted if it has not been rejected by the relevant rights owner before the close of the 28th day after the date of the infringement notice to which it relates.
________________________________________________________________________________________________
Example
A detection notice is issued on Monday, 1 March. A challenge is received by the IPAP on Monday, 15 March. If the challenge is not rejected before the close of Monday, 29 March, it is deemed to be accepted.
________________________________________________________________________________________________
(2)If a challenge to a detection notice is accepted or deemed to be accepted,—
(3)If a challenge to a warning notice or an enforcement notice is accepted or deemed to be accepted,—
Section 122H: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
(1)A rights owner may take enforcement action against an account holder who has been issued with an enforcement notice in respect of infringements against the rights owner by doing either or both of the following:
(2)Nothing in sections 122A to 122U affects the rights and remedies of rights owners under any other provision of this Part in relation to any infringement of copyright, whether or not the infringement has been included in an infringement notice.
Section 122I: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 122I(1)(b): amended, on 1 March 2017, by section 261 of the District Court Act 2016 (2016 No 49).
(1)After an enforcement notice is issued, any application to the Tribunal for an order under section 122O must be made—
________________________________________________________________________________________________
Example
An enforcement notice is issued on Monday, 1 March, and—
(1)by the close of Monday, 15 March, no challenges have been received. The rights owner can apply to the Tribunal at any time after that, up until the close of Sunday, 4 April (end of quarantine period); or
(2)on Monday, 15 March, a valid challenge is received. Whether or not the challenge is rejected, the rights owner cannot apply to the Tribunal until after Monday, 29 March (last day on which challenge could be rejected) and must do so before the close of Sunday, 4 April (end of quarantine period).
________________________________________________________________________________________________
(2)The application must be in a form approved by the chief executive of the Ministry of Justice after consultation with the chairperson of the Tribunal, and include or be accompanied by—
(3)If the Tribunal is satisfied that an enforcement notice has been sent to the account holder in accordance with this Act, the Tribunal must order the relevant IPAP to produce to the Tribunal—
(4)The IPAP must provide those contact details and notices to the Tribunal as soon as practicable.
(5)If an infringement notice expires, and the notice relates to an application made in accordance with subsection (1), the expiry does not affect the continuation and completion of any proceedings.
Section 122J: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 122J(2): amended, on 29 October 2019, by section 6 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
(1)The Tribunal must give notice of the proceedings, in a form approved by the chief executive of the Ministry of Justice after consultation with the chairperson of the Tribunal, to the account holder and any parties that the Tribunal directs to be joined.
(2)The notice of proceedings must—
(3)The parties to proceedings before the Tribunal for an order under section 122O are—
Section 122K: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 122K(1): amended, on 29 October 2019, by section 7 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
(1)Proceedings before the Tribunal for an order under section 122O must be determined on the papers unless—
(2)The papers on which the proceedings are determined are—
(3)The Tribunal may determine its own procedure for determining an application that is dealt with on the papers, subject to any regulations.
(4)The Tribunal must make all reasonable efforts to ensure that, unless it orders otherwise or an order is made against the account holder, the identity and contact details of the account holder are not disclosed to the rights owner.
Section 122L: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
(1)If a hearing is held, sections 211 to 224 apply, other than sections 213(2) and 214(1).
(2)Every party to the proceedings may appear personally and be heard.
(3)A party may not be represented at a hearing by a representative, except as follows:
(4)A representative may not be a lawyer, unless the Tribunal gives leave.
Compare: 1988 No 110 s 38
Section 122M: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
(1)In proceedings before the Tribunal, in relation to an infringement notice, it is presumed—
(2)An account holder may submit evidence that, or give reasons why, any 1 or more of the presumptions in subsection (1) do not apply with respect to any particular infringement identified in an infringement notice.
(3)If an account holder submits evidence or gives reasons as referred to in subsection (2), the rights owner must satisfy the Tribunal that, in relation to the relevant infringement or notice, the particular presumption or presumptions are correct.
Section 122N: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
(1)The Tribunal must order an account holder to pay a rights owner a sum if the Tribunal is satisfied that—
(2)The sum specified in the Tribunal order must be determined in accordance with regulations made under this Act and must include a sum in relation to every infringement identified in the enforcement notice that the Tribunal is satisfied was committed against the rights owner at an IP address of the account holder.
(3)If the Tribunal makes an order under subsection (1), it may also make an order requiring the account holder to pay to the rights owner either or both of the following:
(4)The total amount ordered by the Tribunal to be paid by the account holder must not exceed $15,000.
(5)Despite subsection (1), the Tribunal may decline to make the order required by that subsection if, in the circumstances of the case, the Tribunal is satisfied that making the order would be manifestly unjust to the account holder.
(6)An order made under this section may be enforced as if it were a judgment for a sum of money made by the District Court.
(7)The Tribunal may award costs against a party to the proceedings only if the Tribunal is satisfied that the party has engaged in conduct intended to impede the prompt determination of the proceedings.
Section 122O: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 122O(6): amended, on 1 March 2017, by section 261 of the District Court Act 2016 (2016 No 49).
(1)The District Court may make a suspension order requiring an IPAP to suspend the Internet account of an account holder.
(2)A suspension order may be for any period up to 6 months.
(3)The court may make an order under this section only if it is satisfied that—
(4)When considering the circumstances, and in determining the duration of a proposed suspension, the matters that the court may consider include, but are not limited to,—
(5)An application to the District Court for an order under this section must be made—
Section 122P: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 122P(1): amended, on 1 March 2017, by section 261 of the District Court Act 2016 (2016 No 49).
Section 122P(5): amended, on 1 March 2017, by section 261 of the District Court Act 2016 (2016 No 49).
(1)This section applies if a rights owner wishes to apply for an order under section 122P against an account holder, but does not know the identity of the account holder.
(2)The District Court may make an order requiring an IPAP to disclose to a rights owner, as soon as practicable, the name and contact details of an account holder if—
Section 122Q: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 122Q(2): amended, on 1 March 2017, by section 261 of the District Court Act 2016 (2016 No 49).
(1)No person may apply to the District Court for a suspension order under section 122P, or for an order under section 122Q, until after the date set by Order in Council under this section.
(2)The Governor-General may, by Order in Council made on the recommendation of the Minister, set a date after which applications for orders under sections 122P and 122Q may be made.
(3)An order under subsection (2) is secondary legislation (see Part 3 of the Legislation Act 2019 for publication requirements).
| Legislation Act 2019 requirements for secondary legislation made under this section | ||
| Publication | PCO must publish it on the legislation website and notify LA19 s 69(1)(c) it in the Gazette | LA19 s 69(1)(c) |
| Presentation | The Minister must present it to the House of Representatives | LA19 s 114, Sch 1 cl 32(1)(a) |
| Disallowance | It may be disallowed by the House of Representatives | LA19 ss 115, 116 |
| This note is not part of the Act. | ||
Section 122R: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 122R(1): amended, on 1 March 2017, by section 261 of the District Court Act 2016 (2016 No 49).
Section 122R(3): inserted, on 28 October 2021, by section 3 of the Secondary Legislation Act 2021 (2021 No 7).
(1)An IPAP need not comply with either of the obligations in section 122C(1) in respect of the services it provides by way of a cellular mobile network.
(2)[Repealed]
(3)The Governor-General may, by Order in Council made on the recommendation of the Minister, do all or any of the following:
(4)The powers in subsection (3) may be exercised more than once.
(5)An order under subsection (3) is secondary legislation (see Part 3 of the Legislation Act 2019 for publication requirements).
| Legislation Act 2019 requirements for secondary legislation made under this section | ||
| Publication | PCO must publish it on the legislation website and notify LA19 s 69(1)(c) it in the Gazette | LA19 s 69(1)(c) |
| Presentation | The Minister must present it to the House of Representatives | LA19 s 114, Sch 1 cl 32(1)(a) |
| Disallowance | It may be disallowed by the House of Representatives | LA19 ss 115, 116 |
| This note is not part of the Act. | ||
Section 122S: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 122S(2): repealed, on 30 September 2015, by clause 3 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing and Cellular Mobile Networks) Order 2015 (LI 2015/208).
Section 122S(5): inserted, on 28 October 2021, by section 3 of the Secondary Legislation Act 2021 (2021 No 7).
(1)Every IPAP must retain, for a minimum of 40 days, information on the allocation of IP addresses to each account holder.
(2)Every IPAP must retain, for a minimum of 12 months, the following information:
(3)No IPAP may release the name or contact details of an account holder to a rights owner unless—
(4)On or before 31 December 2012, and annually thereafter, every IPAP must publish on its Internet site a report on its compliance with this section during the period starting on 1 October in the previous year and ending on 30 September in the year of the report.
Section 122T: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
(1)An IPAP may charge a rights owner for performing the functions required of IPAP under sections 122A to 122T.
(2)If regulations are made that prescribe a rate or rates, or a method or methods for calculating the rate or rates, that may be charged by an IPAP, an IPAP must not charge more than the rate or rates prescribed by, or calculated in accordance with, the regulations.
Section 122U: inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
(1)An exclusive licensee has, except against the copyright owner, the same rights and remedies under any of sections 120 to 122P in respect of matters occurring after the grant of the licence as if the licence were an assignment.
(2)The rights and remedies of the exclusive licensee under any of sections 120 to 122P are concurrent with those of the copyright owner.
(3)In proceedings brought by an exclusive licensee pursuant to this section, a defendant may avail himself or herself or itself of any defence that would have been available if the proceedings had been brought by the copyright owner.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 26(2)(a), (b), (4); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 101 (UK)
Section 123(1): amended, on 1 September 2011, by section 7(1) of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 123(2): amended, on 1 September 2011, by section 7(2) of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
(1)Where proceedings for infringement of copyright brought by the copyright owner or an exclusive licensee relate (wholly or partly) to an infringement in respect of which the copyright owner and the exclusive licensee have concurrent rights of action, the copyright owner or, as the case may be, the exclusive licensee may not, without the leave of the court, proceed unless the other is either joined as a plaintiff or added as a defendant.
(2)A copyright owner or exclusive licensee who is joined as a plaintiff or added as a defendant pursuant to subsection (1) is not liable for any costs in the proceedings unless that person takes part in the proceedings.
(3)Subsections (1) and (2) do not affect the granting of interlocutory relief on an application by a copyright owner or exclusive licensee alone.
(4)Whether or not the copyright owner and the exclusive licensee are both parties to proceedings for infringement of copyright that relate (wholly or partly) to an infringement in respect of which they have or had concurrent rights of action,—
(5)The copyright owner shall notify any exclusive licensee having concurrent rights before applying for an order under section 122; and the court may on the application of the licensee make such order under that section as it thinks fit having regard to the terms of the licence.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 26(3)–(8); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 102 (UK)
(1)An infringement of a right conferred by Part 4 is actionable by the person entitled to the right.
(2)In proceedings for infringement of a right conferred by Part 4, relief by way of damages and injunction is available to the plaintiff.
(3)In proceedings for infringement of the right conferred by section 98(2), the court may, if it thinks it is an adequate remedy in the circumstances, grant an injunction on terms prohibiting the doing of any act unless a disclaimer is made, in such terms and in such manner as may be approved by the court, dissociating the author or director from the treatment of the work.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 62(8); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 103 (UK)
(1)The presumptions set out in subsections (2) to (5) apply in proceedings brought under this Act with respect to a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work.
(2)Where a name purporting to be that of the author appeared on copies of a literary, dramatic, or musical work as published or on an artistic work when it was made, the person whose name appeared shall be presumed, until the contrary is proved,—
(3)In the case of a work alleged to be a work of joint authorship, subsection (2) applies in relation to each person alleged to be one of the authors.
(4)Where no name purporting to be that of the author appeared on copies of the work as published or on the work when it was made, but—
the person whose name appeared shall be presumed, until the contrary is proved, to represent the author and shall be entitled to protect and enforce the author’s rights.
(5)If the author of the work is dead or the identity of the author cannot be ascertained by reasonable inquiry, it shall be presumed, until the contrary is proved,—
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 27(2)–(5); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 104 (UK)
(1)This section applies to any proceedings for infringement of copyright in any artistic work of which copies in 3 dimensions have been issued to the public by or with the licence of the owner of the copyright in that artistic work.
(2)In any proceedings to which this section applies, where copies as issued to the public, whether in New Zealand or in any other country, bear a clear and legible label or other mark indicating the following claims, namely,—
it shall be presumed until the contrary is proved—
(3)For the purposes of subsection (2), the symbol “©” on a label or other mark shall be taken to indicate that copyright is claimed to exist in the artistic work of which the copy so labelled or marked is made.
(4)Nothing in this section limits or affects section 126.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 27A; 1985 No 134 s 7(1)
(1)In proceedings brought under this Act with respect to a computer program, where copies of the program are issued to the public in electronic form bearing a statement—
the statement shall be admissible as evidence of the facts stated and shall be presumed to be correct until the contrary is proved.
(2)In proceedings brought under this Act with respect to a sound recording, where copies of the recording as issued to the public bear a label or other mark stating—
the label or mark shall be admissible as evidence of the facts stated and shall be presumed to be correct until the contrary is proved.
(3)In proceedings brought under this Act with respect to a film, where copies of the film as issued to the public bear a statement—
the statement shall be admissible as evidence of the facts stated and shall be presumed to be correct until the contrary is proved.
(4)The presumptions created in subsections (1) to (3) apply in proceedings relating to an infringement alleged to have occurred before the date on which the copies were issued to the public in the same manner as they apply in proceedings relating to an infringement alleged to have occurred after the date on which the copies were issued to the public.
(5)In proceedings brought under this Act with respect to a film, where the film as shown in public or communicated to the public bears a statement—
the statement shall be admissible as evidence of the facts stated and shall be presumed to be correct until the contrary is proved.
(6)The presumption created by subsection (5) applies in proceedings relating to an infringement alleged to have occurred before the date on which the film was shown in public or communicated to the public in the same manner as it appliesin proceedings relating to an infringement alleged to have occurred after the date on which the film was shown in public or communicated to the public.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 27(7); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 105 (UK)
Section 128(5): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 64(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 128(6): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 64(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
In proceedings brought under this Act with respect to a literary, dramatic, or musical work in which Crown copyright exists, where there appears on printed copies of the work a statement of the year in which the work was first published commercially, that statement shall be admissible as evidence of the fact stated and shall be presumed to be correct until the contrary is proved.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 106 (UK)
(1)Where a person brings proceedings alleging an infringement of copyright or a contravention of section 226A, a court may, on the application of any person against whom the proceedings are brought,—
(2)A court shall not grant relief under this section if the person who brought the proceedings proves that the acts in respect of which proceedings were brought constituted, or would have constituted if they had been done, an infringement of the copyright concerned.
(3)Nothing in this section makes a barrister or solicitor of the High Court of New Zealand liable to any proceedings under this section in respect of any act done in his or her professional capacity on behalf of a client.
Compare: 1994 No 116 s 40; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 253 (UK)
Section 130(1): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 65 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Every person commits an offence against this section who, other than pursuant to a copyright licence,—
an object that is, and that the person knows is, an infringing copy of a copyright work.
(2)Every person commits an offence against this section who—
knowing that the object is to be used to make infringing copies for sale or hire or for use in the course of a business.
(3)Subject to subsection (4), every person commits an offence against this section who—
knowing that copyright in the work or, as the case requires, the sound recording or film would be infringed by that performance or, as the case requires, that playing or that showing.
(4)Nothing in subsection (3) applies in respect of infringement of copyright by the reception of a communication work.
(5)Every person who commits an offence against this section is liable on conviction—
(6)Where any person is convicted of an offence against this section in circumstances where that offence involves the making of profit or gain, that offence shall be deemed to have caused a loss of property for the purposes of section 32(1)(a) of the Sentencing Act 2002, and the provisions of that Act relating to the imposition of the sentence of reparation shall apply accordingly.
(7)Sections 126 to 129 (which relate to presumptions) do not apply to proceedings for an offence against this section.
(8)[Repealed]
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 28(1)–(3), (5); 1990 No 71 s 3; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 107 (UK)
Section 131(4): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 66 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 131(5): substituted, on 19 May 1998, by section 6(1) of the Copyright (Removal of Prohibition on Parallel Importing) Amendment Act 1998 (1998 No 20).
Section 131(5): amended, on 20 August 2003, by section 201 of the Trade Marks Act 2002 (2002 No 49).
Section 131(5)(a): amended, on 20 August 2003, by section 201 of the Trade Marks Act 2002 (2002 No 49).
Section 131(5)(b): amended, on 20 August 2003, by section 201 of the Trade Marks Act 2002 (2002 No 49).
Section 131(6): amended, on 30 June 2002, by section 186 of the Sentencing Act 2002 (2002 No 9).
Section 131(8): repealed, on 19 May 1998, by section 6(2) of the Copyright (Removal of Prohibition on Parallel Importing) Amendment Act 1998 (1998 No 20).
[Repealed]
Section 131A: repealed, on 1 July 2013, by section 413 of the Criminal Procedure Act 2011 (2011 No 81).
(1)The court before which proceedings are brought against a person for an offence against section 131 may, if it is satisfied that, at the time of the defendant’s arrest or charge,—
order that the infringing copy or object be delivered up to the copyright owner or to such other person as the court may direct.
(2)An order may be made under subsection (1) by the court of its own motion or on the application of the prosecution, and may be made whether or not the person is convicted of the offence, but shall not be made—
(3)Sections 126 to 129 (which relate to presumptions) apply in proceedings for an order under this section.
(4)A person to whom an infringing copy or other object is delivered up pursuant to an order made under this section shall retain the copy or object pending the making of an order, or the decision not to make an order, under section 134.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 28(4); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 108(1), (3), (5) (UK)
Where any body corporate is convicted of an offence against section 131, every director and every person concerned in the management of the body corporate shall be guilty of the offence if it is proved—
Compare: 1991 No 69 s 340
(1)In proceedings for an offence against section 131, whether by way of a hearing in the first instance or by way of appeal or otherwise, the court may receive an affidavit as evidence of the existence and ownership of copyright.
(2)A party to the proceedings may apply to the court to require a person whose evidence has been given by affidavit to attend the proceedings for the purposes of cross-examination; and the court may make an order accordingly.
Section 133A: inserted, on 20 August 2003, by section 201 of the Trade Marks Act 2002 (2002 No 49).
(1)An application may be made to the court for an order that an infringing copy or other object delivered up pursuant to an order made under section 122 or section 132 shall be—
(2)In considering what order (if any) should be made under subsection (1), the court shall have regard to—
(3)The court shall issue directions as to the service of notice on persons having an interest in the copy or other object.
(4)Any person having an interest in the copy or other object is entitled—
and an order made under subsection (1) shall not take effect until the end of the period within which notice of an appeal may be given or, if before the end of that period notice of appeal is duly given, until the final determination or abandonment of the proceedings on the appeal.
(5)Where there is more than 1 person interested in a copy or other object, the court may direct that the object be sold, or otherwise dealt with, and the proceeds divided, and shall make any other order as it thinks just.
(6)If the court decides that no order should be made under this section, the person in whose possession, custody, or control the copy or other object was before being delivered up is entitled to its return.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 28(4); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 114 (UK)
Part 6A: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Heading: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
The chief executive may appoint enforcement officers, on a permanent or temporary basis, to perform the functions set out in section 134C and exercise the powers conferred on an enforcement officer by this Act.
Section 134A: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)The chief executive must issue a warrant of appointment to every person appointed as an enforcement officer.
(2)A warrant of appointment must—
(3)A warrant of appointment is, in the absence of evidence to the contrary, sufficient proof that the holder of the warrant may exercise the powers conferred on an enforcement officer.
(4)A person who ceases to be an enforcement officer must return the person’s warrant of appointment.
(5)A person who fails to comply with subsection (4) commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding $1,000.
Section 134B: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 134B(5): amended, on 4 October 2013, by regulation 3(1) of the Criminal Procedure (Consequential Amendments) Regulations 2013 (SR 2013/409).
An enforcement officer must, to the extent that is reasonably practicable, promote compliance with this Act by carrying out the following functions:
Section 134C: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Heading: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)For the purpose of carrying out his or her functions, an enforcement officer may enter and examine any place (place A) where goods are being offered for sale, exposed for sale, or publicly displayed if—
(2)In subsection (1),—
place A—
public place means any place that is open to or being used by the public, with or without payment by the public of a charge.
(3)For the purposes of this section, any person who appears to be under 14 years of age may not be treated as the occupier.
Section 134D: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)The power of entry and examination conferred by section 134D authorises an enforcement officer to do any of the following:
(2)A person who assists an enforcement officer exercising the power of entry and examination may, under the direction of the enforcement officer,—
(3)If an enforcement officer enters and examines a place under section 134D(1)(c) and the occupier revokes his or her consent, the officer and any person assisting the enforcement officer must immediately stop the examination and leave the place.
(4)Subsection (3) is subject to subsection (5).
(5)The enforcement officer may, before leaving the place, seize any thing already identified by him or her before the revocation of consent as a thing that he or she has reasonable grounds to believe is evidence of, or of significant relevance to the investigation of, an offence under this Act.
(6)If a member of the Police assists an enforcement officer, nothing in this section prevents that member of the Police from exercising any power ordinarily exercisable by him or her.
(7)Sections 134P to 134S contain further provisions that apply to an enforcement officer’s power of entry and examination.
Section 134E: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Heading: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)An enforcement officer or a member of the Police may apply for a search warrant to search a place or thing.
(2)Any District Court Judge, Justice of the Peace, Community Magistrate, or any Registrar of the District Court (not being a member of the Police) (the issuing officer) may, on an application by an enforcement officer or a member of the Police, issue a search warrant to search a place or thing if the issuing officer is satisfied that there are reasonable grounds for believing that—
(3)Sections 134G to 134S apply in respect of every search warrant applied for and issued under this section.
Section 134F: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 134F(2): amended, on 1 March 2017, by section 261 of the District Court Act 2016 (2016 No 49).
(1)An application for a search warrant must contain, in reasonable detail, the following particulars:
(2)The issuing officer may require the applicant to supply further information concerning the grounds on which the search warrant is sought.
(3)The applicant must disclose in the application—
(4)The applicant must, before making an application for a search warrant, make reasonable inquiries within the agency in which the applicant is employed or engaged for the purpose of complying with subsection (3).
(5)The issuing officer may authorise the search warrant to be executed on more than 1 occasion during the period in which the warrant is in force if he or she is satisfied that this is required for the purposes for which the warrant is being issued.
Section 134G: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)Unless subsection (3) applies, an application for a search warrant—
(2)The applicant must appear in person before the issuing officer, unless subsection (3) applies.
(3)An issuing officer may allow an application for a search warrant to be made verbally (for example, by telephone call) and excuse the applicant from making a personal appearance if the issuing officer is satisfied that—
(4)An issuing officer who allows an application for a search warrant to be made verbally must record the grounds for the application as soon as practicable.
Section 134H: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)Every search warrant issued must be in the prescribed form.
(2)Every search warrant issued must be directed generally to every enforcement officer and every member of the Police.
(3)A search warrant—
(4)Every search warrant must contain, in reasonable detail, the following particulars:
Section 134I: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
If it is not possible for the person charged with executing the warrant to have it in his or her possession at the time of execution, 1 of the following documents (which is deemed for all purposes to constitute the warrant) may be executed:
Section 134J: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)A copy of every written application for a search warrant or, in the case of a verbal application, the written record of the application made by the issuing officer must be retained at the District Court at which, or the District Court that is closest to the place at which, the application was made, until,—
(2)An applicant to whom a search warrant is issued must retain the warrant, a copy of the application (if made in written form), and all documents tendered by the applicant in support of the application until,—
Section 134K: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
A search warrant is executed when the person executing the warrant—
Section 134L: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)Every search warrant authorises the person executing it to do any of the following:
(2)The person executing the warrant may, in a manner and for the duration that is reasonable for the purposes of carrying out the search,—
(3)The powers conferred by this section are subject to any conditions imposed under section 134I(3)(b).
(4)Section 198B of the Summary Proceedings Act 1957 applies with all necessary modifications as if for each reference to a constable there were substituted a reference to the person authorised to execute the search warrant.
Section 134M: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)Every person called on to assist a person executing a warrant is subject to the control of the person executing the warrant.
(2)Every person called on to assist a person executing a warrant may do any of the following:
(3)If a member of the Police is assisting another person executing the warrant, that member of the Police may exercise any power ordinarily exercisable by him or her.
(4)The person executing the warrant must—
Section 134N: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Heading: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)Sections 134P to 134S apply in respect of every search warrant issued under this Act.
(2)Sections 134P(1) and 134Q to 134S apply in respect of the power of entry and examination conferred by section 134D.
(3)In sections 134P to 134S—
Section 134O: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)A person exercising a power of entry and search or a power of entry and examination must,—
(2)The person exercising a power of entry and search is not required to comply with subsection (1) if he or she believes on reasonable grounds that—
(3)The person exercising a power of entry and search may use reasonable force in order to effect entry into or onto the place or thing if—
(4)If the occupier is not present at any time during the exercise of a power of entry and search, the person carrying out the search must,—
(5)The notice required by subsection (4) is a written notice containing the following particulars:
(6)For the purposes of this section and section 134Q, any person who appears to be under 14 years of age may not be treated as the occupier.
(7)Subsections (4) and (5) are subject to sections 134R and 134S.
Section 134P: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)A person who exercises a power of entry and search or a power of entry and examination must, at the time he or she seizes any thing, or as soon as practicable after the seizure of any thing, and in any case not later than 7 days after that seizure, provide to the occupier, and to every other person whom the person who carried out the search or examination has reason to believe is the owner of the thing that was seized,—
(2)A written notice referred to in subsection (1)(a)—
(3)If the occupier is not present at the time of seizure, the written notice referred to in subsection (1)(a) and a copy of the authority referred to in section 134P(1)(b)(i) may be provided to the occupier by leaving the notice in a prominent position at the place or on the thing.
(4)A person who exercises a power of entry and search or a power of entry and examination must make reasonable inquiries for the purposes of complying with subsections (1) and (2).
(5)Subsection (1) is subject to subsections (2) and (3).
(6)This section is subject to sections 134R and 134S.
Section 134Q: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)A person exercising a power of entry and search or a power of entry and examination may apply to a District Court Judge for an order postponing the obligation to comply with section 134P(4) or (5) (in the case of a power of entry and search) or 134Q on the grounds that compliance would—
(2)An application may be made under subsection (1),—
(3)On an application under subsection (1), the District Court Judge may make an order postponing for a specified period not exceeding 12 months the obligation to comply with section 134P(4) or (5) or 134Q, if the Judge is satisfied on either ground set out in subsection (1).
Section 134R: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)A person who has obtained an order under section 134R(3) may, before the expiry of that order, apply to a District Court Judge for a further order for postponement of, or dispensation from, the obligation to comply with section 134P(4) or (5) or 134Q on the grounds set out in section 134R(1).
(2)An application for a further postponement may only be made on 1 occasion.
(3)On an application under subsection (1), the District Court Judge may postpone for a further specified period not exceeding 12 months, or order a permanent dispensation from, the obligation to comply with section 134P(4) or (5) or 134Q, if the Judge is satisfied on either ground set out in section 134R(1).
(4)A District Court Judge may not grant, under subsection (3), any postponement of, or dispensation from, an obligation in respect of any thing that has been seized, unless the thing seized is a copy of any information taken or made.
Section 134S: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Heading: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)A thing seized under this Act may be retained by the Commissioner of Police or by the chief executive while it is required for the purposes of investigating or prosecuting an offence under this Act.
(2)Subsection (1) is subject to—
(3)If a thing seized is no longer required for the purposes of investigating or prosecuting an offence under this Act, the Commissioner of Police or chief executive must return it to the person he or she believes is entitled to it.
(4)The Commissioner of Police or chief executive may apply to the court for an order for directions as to the disposal of the thing if—
(5)On an application under subsection (4), the court may make such order concerning the disposal of the thing that it thinks appropriate in the circumstances.
Section 134T: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)A person who claims to be entitled to a thing seized may apply to the court for an order that the thing be delivered to him or her.
(2)On an application under subsection (1), the court may make an order for delivery of the thing to the applicant if it is satisfied—
Section 134U: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)In any proceedings for an offence relating to a thing seized, the court may, either at the trial or on an application, order—
(2)In considering what order, if any, should be made under subsection (1)(c)(ii), the court must consider the need to ensure that no infringing goods are disposed of in a manner that would adversely affect the copyright owner.
(3)If the court makes an order under subsection (1)(c), it may order that the convicted person pay any reasonable costs incurred by the Commissioner of Police or chief executive in retaining the thing for the purpose of the proceedings.
(4)If no order for delivery, forfeiture, destruction, or other disposal is made in respect of a thing seized and retained for the purpose of proceedings, it must, on completion of the proceedings, be returned by the Commissioner of Police or chief executive to the person entitled to it.
(5)The Commissioner of Police or chief executive may apply to the court for an order for directions as to the disposal of the thing if—
(6)On an application under subsection (5), the court may make any order concerning the disposal of the thing that it thinks appropriate in the circumstances.
Section 134V: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
If, in the opinion of the Commissioner of Police or chief executive, a thing seized may rot, spoil, deteriorate, or otherwise perish, he or she may dispose of it in the way and at the price (if any) or the cost he or she may determine.
Section 134W: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Heading: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)If an enforcement officer believes on reasonable grounds that a person has in his or her possession, custody, or control, 1 or more documents that are evidence of, or may be of significant relevance to the investigation of, an offence against any of sections 131, 198, or 226C, the enforcement officer may apply to a District Court Judge for an order requiring the person to produce the documents for inspection by an enforcement officer.
(2)An application by an enforcement officer for an order under subsection (1) must—
Section 134X: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)If an application is made under section 134X and the District Court Judge is satisfied that there are reasonable grounds to believe that the person in respect of whom the order is sought has in that person’s possession, custody, or control, 1 or more documents that are evidence of, or may be of significant relevance to the investigation of, an offence against any of sections 131, 198, or 226C, the District Court Judge may order the person to produce those documents for inspection by an enforcement officer.
(2)An order under subsection (1)—
Section 134Y: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
An enforcement officer to whom any document is produced for inspection under an order under section 134Y may do 1 or more of the following:
Section 134Z: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)No person may, without reasonable excuse, fail to comply with an order under section 134Y.
(2)Every person who breaches subsection (1) commits an offence and is liable on conviction,—
Section 134ZA: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 134ZA(2): amended, on 4 October 2013, by regulation 3(1) of the Criminal Procedure (Consequential Amendments) Regulations 2013 (SR 2013/409).
Heading: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Every member of the Police has all, and may exercise any, of the powers of an enforcement officer under this Part.
Section 134ZB: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Heading:inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)An order under section 134Y does not affect the privilege against self-incrimination that an individual may have under section 60 of the Evidence Act 2006.
(2)Any assertion of a privilege against self-incrimination must be based on section 60 of the Evidence Act 2006.
(3)If any individual refuses to produce a document on the ground that it is a privileged communication under section 60 of the Evidence Act 2006, an enforcement officer or a member of the Police may apply to a District Court Judge for an order determining whether the claim of privilege is valid; and, in respect of any such application, the individual must offer sufficient evidence to enable the District Court Judge to assess whether self-incrimination would be reasonably likely if the individual produced the document.
(4)To avoid doubt, nothing in this section affects the application of section 65 of the Evidence Act 2006 (which relates to waiver of privilege) in respect of the privilege against self-incrimination that a person may have under section 60 of that Act.
(5)Section 63 of the Evidence Act 2006 does not apply to an order made under section 134Y.
Section 134ZC: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)If, in a criminal proceeding, a person could assert a privilege under section 54 or 56 of the Evidence Act 2006 in respect of a communication or information, that person has the same privilege for the purposes of an examination under section 134D, a search warrant issued under section 134F, and an order made under section 134Y.
(2)Subsection (3) applies to documents that are books of account or accounting records referred to in section 55(1) of the Evidence Act 2006.
(3)The application, by subsection (1), of section 54 of the Evidence Act 2006 (which relates to the privilege for communications with legal advisers) does not prevent, limit, or affect—
(4)A person who has a privilege under this section has the right—
(5)If a person asserts a claim to privilege under this section in respect of any communication or information, an enforcement officer or a member of the Police may apply to a District Court Judge for an order determining whether or not the claim to privilege is valid; and, for the purpose of determining any such application, the District Court Judge may require the communication or information to be produced to him or her.
(6)A District Court Judge may, on the application of an enforcement officer or a member of the Police, disallow a privilege claimed under this section if the Judge is satisfied that the claim to privilege would, under section 67(1) of the Evidence Act 2006, be disallowed in a proceeding.
(7)Section 65 of the Evidence Act 2006 (which relates to waiver of privilege) applies in respect of any privilege under this section.
Section 134ZD: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)The chief executive (or any employee of the Ministry authorised in that behalf), the chief executive of the New Zealand Customs Service (or any employee of the New Zealand Customs Service authorised in that behalf), and the Commissioner of Police (or any member of the Police authorised in that behalf) may disclose information to each other, on request, for the purpose of investigating and prosecuting offences under this Act.
(2)Information obtained under subsection (1) must not be disclosed except—
(3)No obligation as to secrecy or other restriction on the disclosure of information imposed by any enactment or otherwise prevents a disclosure under this section.
Section 134ZE: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)This section applies to—
(2)No person to whom this section applies is liable for any act done or omitted to be done by the person in the performance or intended performance of his or her functions or the exercise or intended exercise of his or her powers under this Act if the person acted—
Section 134ZF: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 6 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
In this Part, unless the context otherwise requires,—
accepted notice means a notice given under section 136(1) that has been accepted by the chief executive under section 136(3)
chief executive has the meaning given to it by section 5(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 2018
claimant means a person who gives a notice under section 136(1)
control of the Customs is to be read in accordance with the definition of subject to the control of Customs in section 6 of the Customs and Excise Act 2018 court means the High Court
Customs means the New Zealand Customs Service
Customs officer has the meaning given to it in section 5(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 2018
exporter has the meaning given to it in section 5(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 2018
importer has the meaning given to it in section 5(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 2018
pirated copy—
(A)constitutes an infringement of copyright under this Act; or
(B)would, if it had been done in New Zealand, have constituted an infringement of copyright under this Act; and
(ia)any other work that is not an infringing copy within the meaning of section 12.
specified item means an item imported, or to be exported, other than for private and domestic use
Section 135 accepted notice: inserted, on 16 September 2011, by section 7 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 135 chief executive: inserted, on 1 October 1996, by section 289(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 1996 (1996 No 27).
Section 135 chief executive: amended, on 1 October 2018, by section 443(3) of the Customs and Excise Act 2018 (2018 No 4).
Section 135 collector: repealed, on 1 October 1996, by section 289(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 1996 (1996 No 27).
Section 135 Comptroller: repealed, on 1 October 1996, by section 289(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 1996 (1996 No 27).
Section 135 control of the Customs: substituted, on 1 October 1996, by section 289(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 1996 (1996 No 27).
Section 135 control of the Customs: amended, on 1 October 2018, by section 443(3) of the Customs and Excise Act 2018 (2018 No 4).
Section 135 Customs: inserted, on 16 September 2011, by section 7 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 135 Customs officer: inserted, on 1 October 1996, by section 289(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 1996 (1996 No 27).
Section 135 Customs officer: amended, on 1 October 2018, by section 443(3) of the Customs and Excise Act 2018 (2018 No 4).
Section 135 exporter: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 9(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 135 importer: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 9(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 135 officer of Customs: repealed, on 1 October 1996, by section 289(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 1996 (1996 No 27).
Section 135 pirated copy paragraph (a)(iii): replaced, on 30 December 2018, by section 9(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 135 pirated copy paragraph (c)(ia): inserted, on 19 May 1998, by section 7 of the Copyright (Removal of Prohibition on Parallel Importing) Amendment Act 1998 (1998 No 20).
Section 135 pirated copy paragraph (c)(ii): repealed, on 20 August 2003, by section 201 of the Trade Marks Act 2002 (2002 No 49).
Section 135 specified item: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 9(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)Any item in the control of the Customs may be detained in the custody of the chief executive or a Customs officer if a Customs officer has reasonable cause to suspect that the item is a pirated copy.
(2)The chief executive must, as soon as is reasonably practicable after the item is detained, take reasonable steps to notify the detention to—
(3)The detention of an item under subsection (1) is not rendered illegal by a failure to serve notice under subsection (2)(a) or (b).
Section 135A: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 10 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)The chief executive may give notice to a person under section 135A(2)(a) or (b)—
(2)A notice that is posted to a person must be treated as received by the person when it would have been delivered in the ordinary course of post and, in proving delivery,—
(3)A notice that is sent to a person at a fax number must, in the absence of proof to the contrary, be treated as received by the person on the day after the date on which it is sent, and in proving sending, it is sufficient to prove that a fax machine generated a record of the transmission of the notice to the fax number.
(4)A notice that is sent to a person by email must, in the absence of proof to the contrary, be treated as received by the person not later than 2 days after the date on which it is sent.
Section 135B: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 10 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)The item is no longer detained under section 135A(1) if—
(2)The chief executive must release any item no longer detained under section 135A(1) to the person entitled to it.
(3)However, the chief executive may release an item under subsection (2) only if the item is not detained under section 140 and if—
Section 135C: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 10 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A person who owns the copyright in any 1 or more literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic works, or 1 or more typographical arrangements of a published edition, or 1 or more sound recordings or films may give a notice in writing to the chief executive—
(2)A notice under subsection (1) shall—
(3)The chief executive shall, in relation to any notice given under subsection (1),—
and shall within a reasonable period of receiving the notice advise the claimant whether the notice has been accepted or declined.
(4)[Repealed]
Section 136: substituted, on 1 October 1996, by section 2 of the Copyright Amendment Act 1996 (1996 No 28).
Section 136(4): repealed, on 16 September 2011, by section 8 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)The chief executive may suspend an accepted notice if the chief executive is satisfied that—
(2)Before suspending an accepted notice, the chief executive must—
(3)The written advice under subsection (2) may be given—
(4)In the absence of proof to the contrary, written advice that is emailed to a person must be treated as received by the person on the second working day after the date on which it is emailed, and, in proving that the advice was emailed, it is sufficient to prove that the advice was properly addressed and sent to the email address.
Section 136A: inserted, on 16 September 2011, by section 9 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 136A(3)(b): amended, on 16 December 2017, by section 52(1) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
Section 136A(3)(c): inserted, on 16 December 2017, by section 52(2) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
Section 136A(4): inserted, on 16 December 2017, by section 52(3) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
(1)If the chief executive decides to suspend an accepted notice, the chief executive must give written notice of the suspension to the person referred to in section 136A(2)(a).
(2)The notice of suspension may be given—
(3)In the absence of proof to the contrary, a notice of suspension that is emailed to a person must be treated as received by the person on the second working day after the date on which it is emailed, and, in proving that the notice was emailed, it is sufficient to prove that the notice was properly addressed and sent to the email address.
Section 136B: inserted, on 16 September 2011, by section 9 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 136B(2)(b): amended, on 16 December 2017, by section 53(1) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
Section 136B(2)(c): inserted, on 16 December 2017, by section 53(2) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
Section 136B(3): inserted, on 16 December 2017, by section 53(3) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
The chief executive may reinstate an accepted notice suspended under section 136A if the chief executive is satisfied that the grounds for the suspension no longer apply.
Section 136C: inserted, on 16 September 2011, by section 9 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)An accepted notice remains in force for the period specified in the notice unless—
(2)However, an accepted notice is not in force during the period of any suspension under section 136A.
Section 136D: inserted, on 16 September 2011, by section 9 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)Where—
the chief executive may conduct such investigation as he or she considers necessary in order to establish whether or not the item appears to be a pirated copy to which the notice relates.
(2)Where the chief executive conducts an investigation, he or she may, subject to section 138, require—
to supply such information as the chief executive may specify for the purpose of the investigation, within 10 working days of being required to do so.
(3)Whether or not the chief executive conducts any investigation, he or she must, within a reasonable period of forming an opinion under subsection (1), make a determination whether or not the item appears to be a pirated copy to which the notice relates.
(4)This section applies only to a specified item.
Section 137: substituted, on 28 July 1997, by section 2 of the Copyright Amendment Act 1997 (1997 No 38).
Section 137(1)(b): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 11(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 137(4): replaced, on 30 December 2018, by section 11(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)The chief executive must not require any person to supply any information under section 137(2) unless the chief executive believes that the information is reasonably necessary for the purposes of an investigation under section 137(1).
(2)Every person who is required to supply information to the chief executive under section 137(2) has the same privileges in relation to the giving of the information as witnesses have in any court.
(3)Where any person refuses or fails to supply information required by the chief executive under section 137(2), the chief executive may, subject to subsection (2), take that refusal or failure into account in forming any opinion under section 137(1) or in making any determination under section 137(3).
Section 138: substituted, on 28 July 1997, by section 2 of the Copyright Amendment Act 1997 (1997 No 38).
(1)Where the chief executive makes a determination under section 137(3), the chief executive must cause written notice of the determination to be served on—
within such period as may reasonably be necessary to effect service.
(2)Every notice required to be served on the claimant or other person under subsection (1) may be given to the claimant or other person—
(2A)A notice that is posted to a claimant or any other person must be treated as served on the claimant or other person at the time when it would have been delivered in the ordinary course of post, and, in proving the delivery,—
(2B)A notice that is faxed to a claimant or any other person must, in the absence of proof to the contrary, be treated as served on the claimant or other person on the day after the date on which it is faxed, and, in proving that it was faxed, it is sufficient to prove that a fax machine generated a record of the transmission of the notice to the fax number.
(2C)In the absence of proof to the contrary, a notice that is emailed to a claimant or any other person must be treated as served on the claimant or other person on the second working day after the date on which it is emailed, and, in proving that the notice was emailed, it is sufficient to prove that the notice was properly addressed and sent to the email address.
(3)The detention of any item under section 140 is not rendered illegal by a failure to serve notice under subsection (1).
Section 139(1): substituted, on 28 July 1997, by section 3 of the Copyright Amendment Act 1997 (1997 No 38).
Section 139(2)(b): replaced, on 16 December 2017, by section 54(1) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
Section 139(2)(c): replaced, on 16 December 2017, by section 54(1) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
Section 139(2)(d): inserted, on 16 December 2017, by section 54(1) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
Section 139(2A): inserted, on 16 December 2017, by section 54(2) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
Section 139(2B): inserted, on 16 December 2017, by section 54(2) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
Section 139(2C): inserted, on 16 December 2017, by section 54(2) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
(1)Where the chief executive has formed an opinion that an item that is in the control of the Customs may be a pirated copy to which a notice accepted under section 136(3)(a) relates, that item shall be detained in the custody of the chief executive or any Customs officer until—
whereupon the item shall, subject to subsection (3), be released to the person entitled to it.
(2)The chief executive may in any particular case extend the period referred to in subsection (1)(e) to 20 working days if he or she considers it appropriate to do so in all the circumstances.
(3)The chief executive or any Customs officer shall not release any item under subsection (1) unless—
Section 140: substituted, on 1 October 1996, by section 289(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 1996 (1996 No 27).
Section 140(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 12(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 140(1)(c): replaced, on 30 December 2018, by section 12(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 140(1)(e): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 12(3) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 140(3)(a): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 12(4) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)Any person may apply to the court for an order that a notice accepted under section 136(3)(a) be discharged, and the court may make such an order accordingly.
(2)Any person may apply to the court for an order that an item detained under section 140 be released, and the court may make such an order accordingly.
(3)Any person may apply to the court for a decision on whether an item that is the subject of a determination made under section 137(3) is a specified item that is a pirated copy, and the court must make a decision accordingly.
(4)Notice of proceedings under subsection (3) shall be served on the chief executive.
(5)In proceedings under subsection (3), the court shall issue directions as to the service of notice on persons having an interest in the item that is the subject of proceedings, and any such person is entitled—
(6)No order made in proceedings under subsection (3) shall take effect until the end of the period within which notice of an appeal may be given or, if before the end of that period notice of appeal is duly given, until the final determination or abandonment of the proceedings on the appeal.
Section 141(3): replaced, on 30 December 2018, by section 13 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 141(4): amended, on 1 October 1996, by section 289(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 1996 (1996 No 27).
If any pirated copies have been detained in the custody of the chief executive or any Customs officer, the importer or exporter of the copies may, by notice in writing to the chief executive, consent to the copies being forfeited to the Crown and, on the giving of such notice, the copies will be forfeited to the Crown.
Section 141A: inserted, on 20 August 2003, by section 201 of the Trade Marks Act 2002 (2002 No 49).
Section 141A: amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 14 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)If, in proceedings under section 141(3), the court decides that an item that is the subject of a determination made under section 137(3) is a specified item that is a pirated copy, the court must make an order that the item be—
(2)In considering what order should be made under subsection (1), the court shall have regard to—
(3)Where more than 1 person is interested in an item, the court may direct that the item be sold, or otherwise dealt with, and the proceeds divided, and shall make any other order as it thinks just.
(4)If, in proceedings under section 141(3), the court decides that an item that is the subject of a determination made under section 141(3) is a specified item but that it is not a pirated copy, the court may make an order that any person who is a party to the proceedings pay compensation in such amount as the court thinks fit to the importer, exporter, or owner of the item.
Section 142(1): replaced, on 30 December 2018, by section 15(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 142(4): replaced, on 30 December 2018, by section 15(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)The chief executive or a Customs officer shall, in respect of any item in his or her possession that is or may be the subject of—
allow any person claiming to have an interest in—
to inspect that item.
(2)A person referred to in subsection (1) may—
(3)Any person who intends to inspect any item under this section shall give the chief executive or Customs officer not less than 72 hours’ notice of his or her intention to inspect that item.
Section 143(1): amended, on 1 October 1996, by section 289(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 1996 (1996 No 27).
Section 143(2): substituted, on 1 October 1996, by section 289(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 1996 (1996 No 27).
Section 143(3): amended, on 1 October 1996, by section 289(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 1996 (1996 No 27).
Heading:inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)A Customs officer may seize any imported goods that are in the control of the Customs if the officer has reasonable cause to believe that they are evidence of, or of significant relevance to the investigation of, an offence against section 131(1)(b), 198(1)(b), or 226C(1).
(2)The provisions of sections 134T to 134W apply with all necessary modifications in respect of any imported goods seized under this section and in applying those provisions every reference to the chief executive must be read as a reference to the chief executive of the New Zealand Customs Service.
Section 144: substituted, on 7 October 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)If a Customs officer believes on reasonable grounds that goods in the control of the Customs have been imported in breach of this Act, the chief executive may, by notice in writing, require any person whom the Customs officer believes to have imported the goods, or any person whom the Customs officer believes to have acted as agent of that person, to produce to a Customs officer for inspection any specified document or class of documents in the person’s possession or control that the Customs officer considers relevant to determining whether the goods should be seized under section 144 or released.
(2)A notice under this section requiring a person to produce any document must—
(2A)In the absence of proof to the contrary, a notice that is emailed to a person must be treated as served on the person on the second working day after the date on which it is emailed, and, in proving that the notice was emailed, it is sufficient to prove that the notice was properly addressed and sent to the email address.
(3)A Customs officer to whom a document is produced for inspection may do 1 or more of the following:
Section 144A: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 144A(2)(d)(iv): replaced, on 1 October 2018, by section 443(3) of the Customs and Excise Act 2018 (2018 No 4).
Section 144A(2)(d)(v): inserted, on 16 December 2017, by section 55(2) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
Section 144A(2A): inserted, on 16 December 2017, by section 55(3) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
(1)If a Customs officer believes on reasonable grounds that goods in the control of the Customs have been imported in breach of this Act, the chief executive may, by notice in writing, require any person whom the Customs officer believes to have imported the goods, or any person whom the Customs officer believes to have acted as agent of that person, to appear before a Customs officer and to answer questions that the Customs officer considers relevant to determining whether the goods should be seized under section 144 or released.
(2)A notice under this section requiring a person to appear before a Customs officer and to answer questions must—
(3)In the absence of proof to the contrary, a notice that is emailed to a person must be treated as served on the person on the second working day after the date on which it is emailed, and, in proving that the notice was emailed, it is sufficient to prove that the notice was properly addressed and sent to the email address.
Section 144B: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 144B(2)(d)(iv): replaced, on 1 October 2018, by section 443(3) of the Customs and Excise Act 2018 (2018 No 4).
Section 144B(2)(d)(v): inserted, on 16 December 2017, by section 56(2) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
Section 144B(3): inserted, on 16 December 2017, by section 56(3) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
(1)If a Customs officer believes on reasonable grounds that a person has in his or her possession, custody, or control, 1 or more documents that are evidence of, or may be of significant relevance to the investigation of, an offence against section 131, 198, or 226C in respect of imported goods, the Customs officer may apply to a District Court Judge for an order requiring the person to produce the documents for inspection by a Customs officer.
(2)An application by a Customs officer for an order under subsection (1) must—
Section 144C: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)If an application is made under section 144C and the District Court Judge is satisfied that there are reasonable grounds to believe that the person in respect of whom the order is sought has in that person’s possession, custody, or control, 1 or more documents that are evidence of, or may be of significant relevance to the investigation of, an offence against section 131, 198, or 226C in respect of imported goods, the District Court Judge may order the person to produce those documents for inspection by a Customs officer.
(2)An order under subsection (1)—
Section 144D: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
A Customs officer to whom any document is produced for inspection under an order under section 144D may do 1 or more of the following:
Section 144E: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)A Customs officer may apply for a search warrant to search a place or thing.
(2)Any District Court Judge, Justice of the Peace, Community Magistrate, or Registrar of the District Court (the issuing officer) may, on an application by a Customs officer, issue a warrant if the issuing officer is satisfied that there are reasonable grounds for believing that there is in, on, over, or under the place or thing any thing that is evidence of, or of significant relevance to the investigation of, an offence against section 131, 198, or 226C in respect of imported goods.
(3)Sections 134G to 134S apply with all necessary modifications in respect of every search warrant applied for and issued under this section.
(4)Sections 134T to 134W apply with all necessary modifications in respect of any thing seized under a search warrant issued under this section, and in applying those provisions every reference to the chief executive must be read as a reference to the chief executive of the New Zealand Customs Service.
Section 144F: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 144F(2): amended, on 1 March 2017, by section 261 of the District Court Act 2016 (2016 No 49).
(1)A notice under section 144A or 144B, or an order under section 144D, does not affect the privilege against self-incrimination that an individual may have under section 60 of the Evidence Act 2006.
(2)Any assertion of a privilege against self-incrimination must be based on section 60 of the Evidence Act 2006.
(3)If any individual refuses to produce any information or document or to answer any question on the ground that it is a privileged communication under section 60 of the Evidence Act 2006, a Customs officer or a member of the Police may apply to a District Court Judge for an order determining whether the claim of privilege is valid; and, in respect of any such application, the individual must offer sufficient evidence to enable the District Court Judge to assess whether self-incrimination would be reasonably likely if the individual produced the information or the document or answered the question.
(4)To avoid doubt, nothing in this section affects the application of section 65 of the Evidence Act 2006 (which relates to waiver of privilege) in respect of the privilege against self-incrimination that a person may have under section 60 of that Act.
(5)Section 63 of the Evidence Act 2006 does not apply to an order under section 144D.
Section 144G: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)If, in a criminal proceeding, a person could assert a privilege under section 54 or 56 of the Evidence Act 2006 in respect of a communication or information, that person has the same privilege for the purposes of a notice issued under section 144A or 144B, an order made under section 144D, and a search warrant issued under section 144F.
(2)Subsection (3) applies to documents that are books of account or accounting records referred to in section 55(1) of the Evidence Act 2006.
(3)The application, by subsection (1), of section 54 of the Evidence Act 2006 (which relates to the privilege for communications with legal advisers) does not prevent, limit, or affect—
(4)A person who has a privilege under this section has the right—
(5)If a person asserts a claim to privilege under this section in respect of any communication or information, a Customs officer or a member of the Police may apply to a District Court Judge for an order determining whether the claim to privilege is valid; and, for the purpose of determining any such application, the District Court Judge may require the communication or information to be produced to him or her.
(6)A District Court Judge may, on the application of a Customs officer or a member of the Police, disallow a privilege claimed under this section if the Judge is satisfied that the claim to privilege would, under section 67(1) of the Evidence Act 2006, be disallowed in a proceeding.
(7)Section 65 of the Evidence Act 2006 (which relates to waiver of privilege) applies in respect of any privilege under this section.
Section 144H: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)No person may, without reasonable excuse, refuse or fail to comply with a notice given under section 144A.
(2)No person who is required by a notice given under section 144B to appear before a Customs officer and to answer questions may, without reasonable excuse,—
(3)No person may, without reasonable excuse, refuse or fail to comply with an order made under section 144D.
(4)Every person who breaches any of subsections (1) to (3) commits an offence and is liable on conviction,—
Section 144I: inserted, on 7 October 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 144I(4): amended, on 4 October 2013, by regulation 3(1) of the Criminal Procedure (Consequential Amendments) Regulations 2013 (SR 2013/409).
Heading:inserted, on 16 September 2011, by section 11 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
(1)With the written consent of the Minister of Customs, the chief executive may from time to time, either generally or particularly, by writing under his or her hand, delegate to any Customs officer all or any of the powers, duties, and functions conferred or imposed on the chief executive by or under this Part.
(2)No delegation under subsection (1) shall include the power to delegate under that subsection.
(3)Subject to any general or special directions given or conditions imposed from time to time by the Minister of Customs or the chief executive, as the case may be, the officer to whom any powers are so delegated may exercise those powers in the same manner and with the same effect as if they had been conferred on that officer directly by this Act and not by delegation.
(4)Every Customs officer purporting to act pursuant to any delegation under this section shall, in the absence of proof to the contrary, be presumed to be acting in accordance with the terms of the delegation.
(5)Any delegation under this section may be made to any specified person or to the holder or holders for the time being of any specified office or class of offices.
(6)Every such delegation shall be revocable at will, and no such delegation shall prevent the exercise of any power by the chief executive.
(7)Any such delegation shall, until revoked, continue in force according to its tenor, notwithstanding the fact that the chief executive by whom it was made has ceased to hold office, and shall continue to have effect as if made by the successor in office of the chief executive.
Section 145: substituted, on 1 October 1996, by section 289(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 1996 (1996 No 27).
Neither the Crown nor the chief executive nor any Customs officer nor any person who assists a Customs officer shall be liable for any loss or damage occasioned by anything done or omitted to be done or purporting to have been done in the exercise of any power, duty, or function under this Part or any regulations made under this Act for the purposes of this Part, unless the chief executive or any Customs officer or any person who assists a Customs officer has not acted in good faith.
Compare: 1966 No 19 s 228A; 1971 No 42 s 10
Section 146: amended, on 7 October 2011, by section 12(1) of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 146: amended, on 7 October 2011, by section 12(2) of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 146: amended, on 1 October 1996, by section 289(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 1996 (1996 No 27).
(1)References in this Part to licences or licensing schemes covering works of more than 1 author do not include licences or licensing schemes covering only—
(2)In subsection (1), group of companies means a holding company and its subsidiaries as defined in sections 5 and 6 of the Companies Act 1993.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 116(4) (UK)
Section 147(2): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 67 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Sections 149 to 155 apply to—
and in those sections the term licensing scheme means a licensing scheme of any of those descriptions.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 117 (UK)
Section 148(a)(iv): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 68(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 148(b): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 68(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 148(d)(iii): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 68(3) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 148(d)(iv): repealed, on 31 October 2008, by section 68(3) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The terms of a licensing scheme that—
may be referred to the Tribunal by—
(2)The Tribunal shall first decide whether to entertain the reference and may decline to do so on the ground that the reference is premature.
(3)If the Tribunal decides to entertain the reference, it shall consider the matter referred and make such order, either confirming or varying the proposed scheme, either generally or so far as it relates to cases of the description to which the reference relates, as the Tribunal may determine to be reasonable in the circumstances.
(4)The order may be made so as to be in force indefinitely or for such period as the Tribunal may determine.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 118 (UK)
(1)If, while a licensing scheme is in operation, a dispute arises between the operator of the scheme and—
the operator or that person or organisation may refer the scheme, in so far as it relates to cases of that description, to the Tribunal.
(2)A scheme that has been referred to the Tribunal under this section shall remain in operation until proceedings on the reference are concluded.
(3)The Tribunal shall consider the matter in dispute and make such order, either confirming or varying the scheme so far as it relates to cases of the description to which the reference relates, as the Tribunal may determine to be reasonable in the circumstances.
(4)The order may be made so as to be in force indefinitely or for such period as the Tribunal may determine.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 39(1), (3)–(5)(a); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 119 (UK)
(1)Where the Tribunal has on a previous reference of a licensing scheme (whether under this section or section 149 or section 150), made an order with respect to the scheme, then, subject to subsection (2), while the order remains in force,—
may again refer the scheme, so far as it relates to cases of that description, to the Tribunal.
(2)Except with the special leave of the Tribunal, a licensing scheme shall not be referred again to the Tribunal under subsection (1) in respect of the same description of cases at a time earlier than—
whichever occurs first.
(3)A scheme that has been referred to the Tribunal under this section shall remain in operation until proceedings on the reference are concluded.
(4)The Tribunal shall consider the matter in dispute and make such order, either confirming, varying, or further varying the scheme so far as it relates to cases of the description to which the reference relates, as the Tribunal may determine to be reasonable in the circumstances.
(5)The order may be made so as to be in force indefinitely or for such period as the Tribunal may determine.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 40; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 120 (UK)
(1)A licensing scheme that has been confirmed or varied by an order of the Tribunal made under section 149 or section 150 or section 151 shall be in force or, as the case may be, remain in operation so far as it relates to cases of the description in respect of which the order was made, so long as the order remains in force.
(2)While an order is in force, a person who, in a case of a class to which the order applies,—
shall be in the same position as regards infringement of copyright as if that person had at all material times been the holder of a licence granted by the owner of the copyright in question in accordance with the scheme.
(3)The Tribunal may direct that the order, so far as it varies the amount of charges payable, has effect from a date before that on which the order is made, but not earlier than the date on which the reference was made or, if later, on which the scheme came into operation.
(4)If such a direction is made,—
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 39(5)(b), 45(1)–(3); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 123(1)–(3) (UK)
(1)A person who claims, in a case covered by a licensing scheme, that the operator of the scheme has refused to grant to that person or procure the grant to that person of a licence in accordance with the scheme, or has failed to do so within a reasonable time after being asked, may apply to the Tribunal for a licence.
(2)A person who claims, in a case excluded from a licensing scheme,—
may apply to the Tribunal.
(3)A case shall be regarded as excluded from a licensing scheme for the purposes of subsection (2) if—
(4)If the Tribunal is satisfied that the claim is well-founded, it shall make an order declaring that, in respect of the matters specified in the order, the applicant is entitled to a licence on such terms as the Tribunal may determine to be applicable in accordance with the scheme or, as the case may be, to be reasonable in the circumstances.
(5)The order may be made so as to be in force indefinitely or for such period as the Tribunal may determine.
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 36(3), 38(1)–(4); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 121 (UK)
(1)Where the Tribunal has made an order under section 153 that a person is entitled to a licence under a licensing scheme, the operator of the scheme or the original applicant may from time to time apply to the Tribunal to review the order.
(2)Except with the special leave of the Tribunal, an application shall not be made under subsection (1) at a time earlier than—
whichever occurs first.
(3)The Tribunal shall on an application for review under this section confirm or vary its order as the Tribunal may determine to be reasonable having regard to the terms applicable in accordance with the licensing scheme or, as the case may be, the circumstances of the case.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 122 (UK)
Where the Tribunal has made an order under section 153 and the order remains in force, the person in whose favour the order is made shall, if that person—
be in the same position as regards infringement of copyright as if that person had at all material times been the holder of a licence granted by the owner of the copyright in question on the terms specified in the order.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 45(1)–(3); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 123(5) (UK)
Sections 157 to 160 apply to the following descriptions of licences granted by a licensing body otherwise than under a licensing scheme:
and in those sections the term licence means a licence of any of those descriptions.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 124 (UK)
Section 156(a)(iii): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 69(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 156(b): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 69(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The terms on which a licensing body proposes to grant a licence may be referred to the Tribunal by the licensing body or the prospective licensee.
(2)The Tribunal shall first decide whether to entertain the reference, and may decline to do so on the ground that the reference is premature.
(3)If the Tribunal decides to entertain the reference, it shall consider the terms of the proposed licence and make such order, either confirming or varying the terms, as it may determine to be reasonable in the circumstances.
(4)The order may be made so as to be in force indefinitely or for such period as the Tribunal may determine.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 125 (UK)
(1)A licensee under a licence that is due to expire, either by effluxion of time or as a result of notice given by the licensing body, may refer the licence to the Tribunal on the ground that it is unreasonable in the circumstances that the licence should cease to be in force.
(2)Such a reference may not be made earlier than the beginning of the period of 3 months immediately before the licence is due to expire.
(3)A licence in respect of which a reference has been made to the Tribunal under this section shall remain in operation until proceedings on the reference are concluded.
(4)If the Tribunal finds the reference well-founded, it shall make an order declaring that the licensee shall continue to be entitled to the benefit of the licence on such terms as the Tribunal may determine to be reasonable in the circumstances.
(5)An order of the Tribunal under this section may be made so as to be in force indefinitely or for such period as the Tribunal may determine.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 126 (UK)
(1)Where the Tribunal has made an order under section 157 or section 158, the licensing body or the person entitled to the benefit of the order may apply to the Tribunal to review the order.
(2)Except with the special leave of the Tribunal, an application shall not be made under subsection (1) at a time earlier than—
whichever occurs first.
(3)The Tribunal shall on an application for review under this section confirm or vary its order as the Tribunal may determine to be reasonable in the circumstances.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 127 (UK)
(1)Where the Tribunal has made an order under section 157 or section 158 and the order remains in force, the person entitled to the benefit of the order shall, if that person—
be in the same position as regards infringement of copyright as if that person had at all material times been the holder of a licence granted by the owner of the copyright in question on the terms specified in the order.
(2)The benefit of the order may be assigned,—
(3)The Tribunal may direct that an order made under section 157 or section 158, or an order made under section 159 varying such an order, so far as it varies the amount of charges payable, has effect from a date before that on which the order is made, but not earlier than the date on which the reference or application was made or, if later, on which the licence was granted or, as the case may be, was due to expire.
(4)If such a direction is made,—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 128 (UK)
In determining what is reasonable on a reference or application under this Part relating to a licensing scheme or licence, the Tribunal shall have regard to—
and shall exercise its powers so as to ensure that there is no unreasonable discrimination between licensees, or prospective licensees, under the scheme or licence to which the reference or application relates and licensees under other schemes operated by, or other licences granted by, the same person.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 129 (UK)
Where a reference or application is made under this Part relating to the licensing of reprographic copying of published literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic works, or the typographical arrangements of published editions, the Tribunal shall have regard to—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 130 (UK)
(1)This section applies to references or applications made under this Part in relation to licences for—
(2)When this section applies, the Tribunal must, in considering what charges (if any) should be paid for a licence, have regard to the extent to which the owners of the copyright in the works included in the communication work have already received, or are entitled to receive, payment in respect of their inclusion.
Section 163: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 70 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)Where a reference or application is made under this Part in respect of a licence relating to a sound recording, film, or communication work that includes, or is to include, any entertainment or other event, the Tribunal—
(2)Nothing in this section shall require the Tribunal to have regard to any such conditions in so far as they—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 132 (UK)
Section 164(1): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 71(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 164(2)(b): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 71(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)In considering what charges (if any) should be paid for a licence on a reference or application made under this Part in relation to licences for the rental to the public of copies of computer programs, sound recordings, or films, the Tribunal shall take into account any reasonable payments that the owner of copyright in the computer program, sound recording, or film is liable to make, in consequence of the granting of the licence or of the acts authorised by the licence, to owners of copyright in works included in the program, recording, or film.
(2)On any reference or application made under this Part in relation to licensing in respect of copyright in sound recordings, films, or communication works, the Tribunal shall take into account, in considering what charges (if any) should be paid for a licence, any reasonable payments that the copyright owner is liable to make, in consequence of the granting of the licence or of the acts authorised by the licence, in respect of any performance included in the recording, film, or communication work.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 133 (UK)
Section 165(2): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 72(a) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 165(2): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 72(b) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)This section applies to applications under this Part in relation to licences to include literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic works or sound recordings or films in a communication work when one communication work (in this section referred to as the first transmission) is, by reception and immediate retransmission, to be further communicated to the public (in this section referred to as the further transmission).
(2)So far as the further transmission is to the same area as the first transmission, the Tribunal shall, in considering what charges (if any) should be paid for licences for either transmission, have regard to the extent to which the copyright owner has already received, or is entitled to receive, payment for the other transmission that adequately remunerates the copyright owner in respect of transmissions to that area.
(3)So far as the further transmission is to an area outside that to which the first transmission is made, the Tribunal shall not take the further transmission into account in considering what charges (if any) should be paid for licences for the first transmission.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 134 (UK)
Section 166(1): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 73 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)This section applies to—
where the scheme or licence does not specify the works to which it applies with such particularity as to enable licensees to determine whether a work falls within the scheme or licence by inspection of the scheme or licence and the work.
(2)There is implied—
against any liability incurred by the licensee by reason of the licensee having infringed copyright by making or authorising the making of reprographic copies of a work in circumstances within the apparent scope of the licence.
(3)For the purposes of this section, the circumstances of a case are within the apparent scope of a licence if—
(4)In this section, the term liability includes liability to pay costs; and this section applies in relation to costs reasonably incurred by a licensee in connection with actual or contemplated proceedings against the licensee for infringement of copyright and to sums that the licensee is liable to pay in respect of such infringement.
(5)A scheme or licence to which this section applies may contain reasonable provision—
of the operator’s or, as the case may be, the licensing body’s liability to indemnify under such an undertaking.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 136 (UK)
(1)Where—
either party may apply to the Tribunal to determine the remuneration to be paid.
(2)The Tribunal shall consider the matter and make such order as it may determine to be reasonable in the circumstances.
(3)Either party to an order made under this section may apply to the Tribunal to review its order.
(4)Except with the special leave of the Tribunal, an application under subsection (3) shall not be made earlier than the end of the period of 12 months from the date of the original order or of the order on a previous application under that subsection.
(5)The Tribunal shall on an application for review under this section confirm or vary its original order as the Tribunal may determine to be reasonable in the circumstances of the case.
(6)An order under subsection (5) has effect from the date on which it is made or such later date as may be specified by the Tribunal.
Section 168(1)(e): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 74 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)In this Part, unless the context otherwise requires,— commercial exploitation means—
convention country means an entity (whether a State, part of a State, a territory for whose international relations a State is responsible, a political union, an international organisation, or any other entity) that is a party to an international agreement or arrangement relating to performers’ rights
copy, in relation to a recording,—
exclusive performer’s rights licence means a licence in writing signed by or on behalf of the person entitled to exercise a performer’s property rights that authorises the licensee to the exclusion of all other persons, including the person granting the licence, to do anything requiring the consent of the person entitled to exercise the rights
exclusive recording contract means a contract between a performer and another person under which that person is entitled, to the exclusion of all other persons (including the performer), to make recordings or copies of recordings for the purposes of commercial exploitation
illicit recording—
performance—
performers’ property rights means the rights conferred by subpart 4
person having recording rights includes—
recording, in relation to a performance, means a sound recording or film—
(2)In sections 197 and 199, illicit recording includes the following:
Compare: Copyright Act 1968 s 248A(2) (Aust); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 180(2) (UK)
Section 169(1) commercial exploitation paragraph (d): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 75(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 169(1) convention country: substituted, on 14 October 1999, by section 2(2) of the Copyright Amendment Act 1999 (1999 No 124).
Section 169(1) exclusive performer’s rights licence: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 16(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 169(1) performers’ property rights: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 16(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 169(1) recording paragraph (b): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 75(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 169(2): inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 16(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)[Repealed]
(2)[Repealed]
(3)[Repealed]
(4)The rights conferred by this Part are independent of—
(5)The rights conferred by this Part on a performer are conferred only in relation to performances by that performer, whether alone or with others.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 180(3), (4) (UK)
Section 170 heading: replaced, on 30 December 2018, by section 17(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 170(1): repealed, on 30 December 2018, by section 17(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 170(2): repealed, on 30 December 2018, by section 17(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 170(3): repealed, on 30 December 2018, by section 17(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 170(4)(a): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 17(3) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 170(4)(a): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 76 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Subpart 1: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 18 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Heading:inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 18 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A performer’s rights are infringed by a person referred to in subsection (2) if the performer is not identified in accordance with section 170B.
(2)The person is a person who—
(3)Subsection (2)(c) and (d) applies only to a recording that is a sound recording.
(4)Subsection (1) is subject to sections 170B to 170D and 170H.
Section 170A: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 18 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)For the purposes of section 170A, the performer has the right to,—
(2)In any of the cases in subsections (1)(a) to (d), the performer and the person may agree that, for the purposes of section 170A, the person may instead identify the performer in any other manner.
(3)If the assertion under section 170C specifies a pseudonym, initials, or some other particular form of identification, that form must be used, but, in any other case, any reasonable form of identification may be used.
(4)A performer’s rights are not infringed as referred to in section 170A, in relation to a performance given by a group, if,—
(5)In this section, group means 2 or more performers who have a particular name by which they may be identified collectively.
Section 170B: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 18 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A person does not infringe a performer’s rights by failing to identify the performer in the circumstances described in section 170A unless the right to be identified has been asserted under this section in such a way as to require that person to so identify the performer.
(2)The right may be asserted generally, or in relation to any specified circumstances,—
(3)The persons bound by an assertion of the right under subsection (2) are,—
(4)In an action for infringement of the right, the court must, in considering remedies, take into account any delay in asserting the right.
Section 170C: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 18 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
A performer’s rights are not infringed as referred to in section 170A in any of the following cases:
Section 170D: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 18 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Heading:inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 18 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A performer’s rights are infringed by a person if the person subjects a performance to derogatory treatment.
(2)Subsection (1) is subject to sections 170F to 170H.
Section 170E: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 18 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)For the purpose of section 170E, a person subjects a performance to derogatory treatment if the person,—
(2)Subsection (1) applies only to a recording that is a sound recording.
Section 170F: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 18 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
A performer’s rights are not infringed as referred to in section 170E in any of the following cases:
Section 170G: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 18 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Heading:inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 18 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A performer’s rights are not infringed as referred to in sections 170A and 170E—
(2)A waiver—
Section 170H: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 18 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)The right conferred by section 170A applies in relation to the whole or any substantial part of a performance.
(2)The right conferred by section 170E applies in relation to the whole or any part of a performance.
Section 170I: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 18 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Subpart 2 heading: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 18 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Heading:repealed, on 30 December 2018, by section 19 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A performer’s rights are infringed by a person who, without the performer’s consent,—
(2)In proceedings for infringement of a performer’s rights brought under this section, damages shall not be awarded against a defendant who shows that at the time of the infringement the defendant believed on reasonable grounds that the performer’s consent had been given.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 182 (UK)
Section 171(1)(b): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 77 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
A person (A) infringes a performer’s rights if,—
Section 172: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 78 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 172: amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 20(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 172(a): replaced, on 30 December 2018, by section 20(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Subpart 3 heading: heading, on 30 December 2018, by section 21 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A performer’s rights are infringed by a person who, without the performer’s consent and otherwise than for that person’s private and domestic use, copies a recording that is a film if the person knows or has reason to believe that the recording was made without the performer’s consent.
(2)In proceedings for infringement of a performer’s rights brought under this section, damages shall not be awarded against a defendant who shows that at the time of the infringement the defendant believed on reasonable grounds that the performer’s consent to the recording had been given.
(3)A performer’s rights are infringed by a person who, without the performer’s consent and otherwise than for that person’s private and domestic use, copies a recording that is a film—
(4)In proceedings for infringement of a performer’s rights brought under this section, damages shall not be awarded against a defendant who shows that at the time of the infringement the defendant believed on reasonable grounds that the performer’s consent to the copying of the recording had been given.
Section 173 heading: amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 22(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 173(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 22(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 173(3): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 22(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A performer’s rights are infringed by a person who, without the performer’s consent,—
a recording that is a film and that is, and that the person knows or has reason to believe is, an illicit recording.
(2)Where, in proceedings for infringement of a performer’s rights brought under this section, a defendant shows that the recording was innocently acquired by the defendant or a predecessor in title of the defendant, the only remedy available against the defendant in respect of the infringement is damages not exceeding a reasonable payment in respect of the act complained of.
(3)In subsection (2), the term innocently acquired means that the person acquiring the recording did not know, and had no reason to believe, that it was an illicit recording.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 184 (UK)
Section 174(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 23 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Subpart 4: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 24 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
This subpart applies only to recordings that are sound recordings.
Section 174A: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 24 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
A performer’s rights are infringed by a person who, without the performer’s consent, and by means of a recording,—
Section 174B: replaced, on 31 May 2023, by section 4 of the United Kingdom Free Trade Agreement Legislation Act 2022 (2022 No 59).
(1)A performer’s rights are infringed by a person who, without the performer’s consent, copies a recording of the whole or a substantial part of a performance.
(2)Subsection (1) does not apply if—
(3)However, subsection (2) does not apply if the owner of the recording is bound by a contract that specifies the circumstances in which the recording may be copied.
Section 174C: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 24 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A performer’s rights are infringed by a person who, without the performer’s consent, issues to the public a copy of a recording, including the original recording, of the whole or any substantial part of a performance.
(2)Subsection (1) does not apply to a copy of a recording if the copy is imported into New Zealand and—
(3)In subsection (2) (other than paragraph (b)(iii)), property rights means intellectual property rights related to the performance that are equivalent to the performers’ property rights conferred by this subpart.
Section 174D: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 24 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Subpart 5 heading: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 24 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Heading:repealed, on 30 December 2018, by section 25 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)The rights conferred by subparts 2 to 4 are not infringed by—
(2)For the purposes of this section, a performance or recording, so far as it consists of—
shall not be regarded as incidentally copied in another work if the performance or recording is deliberately copied.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 2 para 3 (UK)
Section 175(1): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 79 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 175(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
A reproduction of a recording of a performance of a work does not infringe the rights conferred by subparts 2 to 4 in the recording if the reproduction—
Section 175A: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 80 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 175A: amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Fair dealing with a performance or recording—
does not infringe any of the rights conferred by subparts 2 to 4.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 2 para 2 (UK)
Section 176: amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)The rights conferred by subparts 2 to 4 are not infringed by the copying of a recording of a performance if—
where the lesson is on how to make films or film soundtracks or relates to the learning of a language or is conducted by correspondence; and
(2)The rights conferred by subparts 2 to 4 are not infringed—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 2 para 4(1), (2) (UK)
Section 177(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 177(2): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)The playing or showing of a sound recording, film, or communication work at an educational establishment for the purposes of instruction before an audience consisting of persons who are students or staff members at the establishment or persons directly connected with the activities of the establishment does not infringe any of the rights conferred by subparts 2 to 4.
(2)For the purposes of this section, a person shall not be treated as a person directly connected with the activities of an educational establishment by reason only that the person is a parent or guardian of a student at that educational establishment.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 2 para 5 (UK)
Section 178 heading: amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 81(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 178(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 178(1): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 81(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
A recording of a communication work, or a copy of such a recording, may be made by or on behalf of an educational establishment for the educational purposes of that establishment without infringing any of the rights conferred by subparts 2 to 4 in relation to any performance or recording included in the recording or copy.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 2 para 6(1) (UK)
Section 179 heading: amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 82(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 179: amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 179: amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 82(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Where a recording, or a copy of a recording, that would otherwise be an illicit recording—
it shall be treated as an illicit recording—
(2)In subsection (1), the term dealt with means sold or let for hire, or offered or exposed for sale or hire, in the course of a business.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 2 paras 4(3), 6(2) (UK)
Section 180(1)(a): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
The rights conferred by subparts 2 to 4 are not infringed by anything done for the purposes of parliamentary or judicial proceedings or for the purposes of reporting such proceedings.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 2 para 8 (UK)
Section 181: amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
The rights conferred by subparts 2 to 4 are not infringed by anything done for the purposes of a Royal commission, a commission of inquiry, a ministerial inquiry, or a statutory inquiry.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 2 para 9 (UK)
Section 182: amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)Where the doing of a particular act is specifically authorised by an enactment, the doing of that act does not infringe the rights conferred by subparts 2 to 4 unless the enactment provides otherwise.
(2)Nothing in this section shall be construed as excluding any defence of statutory authority otherwise available under or pursuant to any enactment.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 2 para 11 (UK)
Section 183(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)It is not an infringement of the rights conferred by subparts 2 to 4 to use a recording of a reading or recitation of a literary work (or to copy the recording and use the copy) if—
(2)The conditions referred to in subsection (1) are that—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 2 para 13 (UK)
Section 184(1): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 83(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 184(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 184(2)(a): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 83(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)A recording of a performance of a song may be made for the purpose of including the song in an archive maintained by a body prescribed by regulations made under this Act without infringing any of the rights conferred by subparts 2 to 4, if the conditions in subsection (2) are complied with.
(2)The conditions referred to in subsection (1) are that—
(3)Copies of a recording made in reliance on subsection (1) and included in an archive maintained by a body prescribed by regulations made under this Act may, if the condition contained in subsection (4) is complied with, be made and supplied by the archivist without infringing any of the rights conferred by subparts 2 to 4.
(4)The condition referred to in subsection (3) is that no person is furnished with more than 1 copy of the same recording.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 2 para 14 (UK)
Section 185(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 185(3): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)It is not an infringement of any right conferred by subparts 2 to 4 to play a sound recording as part of the activities of, or for the benefit of, a club, society, or other organisation, if the conditions contained in subsection (2) are complied with.
(2)The conditions referred to in subsection (1) are—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 2 para 15 (UK)
Section 186(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A person who proposes to communicate a recording of a performance to the public in circumstances not infringing rights under subparts 2 to 4 does not require consent for the purposes of subparts 2 to 4 to the making of the further recording if the conditions in subsection (2) are complied with.
(2)The conditions referred to in subsection (1) are that the further recording—
(3)A recording made in accordance with this section is treated as an illicit recording—
Section 187: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 84 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 187(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 187(2)(a): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)The free public playing or showing of a communication work (other than a communication work to which section 188A applies) does not infringe a right under subparts 2 to 4 in relation to a performance or recording included in—
(2)For the purposes of this section, the public playing or showing of a communication work is not free if—
(3)For the purposes of subsection (2)(a), the following persons must not be treated as having paid for admission to the venue:
Section 188: substituted, on 16 September 2011, by section 13(1) of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 188(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)This section applies to the playing or showing of a communication work that—
(2)The free public playing or showing of a communication work to which this section applies does not infringe a right under subparts 2 to 4 in relation to a performance or recording included in—
(3)For the purposes of this section, the public playing or showing of a communication work is not free if—
(4)For the purposes of subsection (3)(a), the following persons must not be treated as having paid for admission to the venue:
Section 188A: inserted, on 16 September 2011, by section 13(1) of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 188A(2): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Where the making of a communication work is an infringement of rights under subparts 2 to 4 in relation to a performance or recording, the fact that the work was heard or seen in public by the reception of the communication work must be taken into account in assessing the damages for the infringement.
Section 188B: inserted, on 16 September 2011, by section 13(1) of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 188B heading: amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 188B: amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 26(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
[Repealed]
Section 189: repealed, on 31 October 2008, by section 86 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)A prescribed body that makes a recording of a communication work for the purpose of providing people who are deaf or hard of hearing or physically or mentally disabled in any other way with copies that are subtitled or otherwise modified for their special needs, does not infringe any right under this Part in relation to a performance or recording included in that communication work.
(2)A body must not be prescribed for the purposes of subsection (1) if it is established or conducted for profit.
Section 190: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 87 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)Any person (A) who records, or makes a copy of a recording of, a communication work does not infringe any right under this Part in relation to a performance or recording included in the communication work if—
(2)A body must not be prescribed for the purposes of subsection (1) if it is established or conducted for profit.
Section 191: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 88 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Where a person wishes to make a copy of a recording but—
the person may apply to the Tribunal for consent to make the copy.
(2)The Tribunal may, subject to the provisions of this section, make an order giving consent to the making of the copy and may impose such conditions on the order as it thinks fit.
(3)The consent given by the Tribunal under subsection (2) has effect as the consent of the performer for the purposes of the provisions of this Part relating to performers’ rights.
(4)The Tribunal shall not give consent under subsection (2) unless satisfied that such directions as to the service or publication of notices as the Tribunal may give have been complied with.
(5)The Tribunal shall not give consent under subsection (2) unless satisfied that the performer’s reasons for withholding consent do not include the protection of any legitimate interests of the performer; but it shall be for the performer to show what his or her reasons are for withholding consent, and in default of evidence as to his or her reasons the Tribunal may draw such inferences as it thinks fit.
(6)In any case the Tribunal shall take into account the following factors:
(7)Where the Tribunal gives consent under this section, it shall, in default of agreement between the applicant and the performer, make such order as it thinks fit as to the payment to be made to the performer in consideration of consent being given.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 190 (UK)
(1)The purpose of this section is to allow certain acts to be done without infringing a performer’s property rights.
(2)For the purposes of subpart 4, sections 53, 55, 56, 56A, 57, 58, 79, 82, 83, and 90 apply with all necessary modifications as if—
Section 192A: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 27 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Subpart 6 heading: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 27 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
The rights conferred by this Part exist in relation to a performance until the end of the period of 50 years from the end of the calendar year in which the performance takes place.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 191 (UK)
(1)The rights conferred by this Part are transmissible only in accordance with sections 194A to 194J.
(2)References in this Part to the performer, in the context of the person having rights conferred by this Part, must be construed as references to the person for the time being entitled to exercise those rights.
Section 194: replaced, on 30 December 2018, by section 29 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
The rights conferred by sections 170A and 170E are not assignable.
Section 194A: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 29 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)On the death of a person entitled to the rights conferred by sections 170A and 170E,—
(2)If, under subsection (1)(a) or (b), a right becomes exercisable by more than 1 person,—
(3)Any damages recovered by personal representatives under this section in respect of an infringement after a person’s death devolve as part of his or her estate as if the right of action had existed and been vested in him or her immediately before his or her death.
Section 194B: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 29 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
The rights conferred by sections 171 to 174 are not assignable.
Section 194C: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 29 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)On the death of a person entitled to the rights conferred by sections 171 to 174,—
(2)If, under subsection (1)(a), a right becomes exercisable by more than 1 person, it is exercisable by each of them independently of the other or others.
(3)Any damages recovered by personal representatives under this section in respect of an infringement after a person’s death devolve as part of his or her estate as if the right of action had existed and been vested in him or her immediately before his or her death.
Section 194D: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 29 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A performer’s property rights are transmissible, as personal or moveable property, by—
(2)Transmission of a performer’s property rights may be partial, that is, limited so as to apply—
(3)If a performer’s property rights become exercisable by more than 1 person, the rights are not exercisable independently and must be exercised by all rights holders acting together.
Section 194E: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 29 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
An assignment of a performer’s property rights is not effective unless it is in writing signed by or on behalf of the assignor.
Section 194F: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 29 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)This section applies if, under a testamentary disposition (whether general or specific), a person is entitled beneficially or otherwise to any material thing containing an original recording of a performance that was not published before the death of the testator.
(2)The testamentary disposition must be construed as including any performers’ property rights in relation to the recording in so far as the testator was the person entitled to exercise the performers’ property rights immediately before the testator’s death.
(3)Subsection (2) does not apply if a contrary intention is indicated in the testator’s will or a codicil to it.
Section 194G: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 29 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)This section applies if a performer purports to assign future property rights (wholly or partially) to another person by an agreement signed by or on behalf of the performer.
(2)If, on the rights coming into existence, the assignee or the assignee’s successor in title would be entitled as against all other persons to require the rights to be vested in the assignee or the assignee’s successor in title, they vest in the assignee or the assignee’s successor in title by virtue of this subsection.
(3)A licence granted by a person to whom future property rights have been assigned is binding on every successor in title to that person’s interest in the rights, except—
(4)In this section, future property rights means a performer’s property rights that will or may come into existence in respect of a future recording of a performance.
Section 194H: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 29 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Heading:inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 29 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A licence granted by a person entitled to exercise a performer’s property rights is binding on every successor in title to that person’s interest in the rights, except—
(2)The licensee under an exclusive performer’s rights licence has the same rights against a successor in title who is bound by the licence as that licensee has against the person who granted the licence.
Section 194I: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 29 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)The licensee under an exclusive performer’s rights licence has, except against the person granting the licence, the same rights and remedies under this Part in respect of matters occurring after the grant of the licence as if the licence were an assignment.
(2)The rights and remedies of the licensee under an exclusive performer’s rights licence under this Part are concurrent with those of the person granting the licence.
(3)In proceedings brought by the licensee under an exclusive performer’s rights licence under this section, a defendant may avail himself or herself or itself of any defence that would have been available if the proceedings had been brought by the person granting the licence.
Section 194J: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 29 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)This section applies if—
(2)The performer or, as the case may be, the licensee may not, without the leave of the court, proceed with the proceedings unless the other is either joined as a plaintiff or added as a defendant.
(3)A performer or licensee who is joined as a plaintiff or added as a defendant under subsection (2) is not liable for any costs in the proceedings unless that person takes part in the proceedings.
(4)Subsections (2) and (3) do not affect the granting of interlocutory relief on an application by a performer or licensee alone.
(5)Whether or not the performer and the licensee are both parties to proceedings for infringement of a performer’s rights that relate (wholly or partly) to an infringement in respect of which they have or had concurrent rights of action,—
(6)The performer must notify any licensee who has concurrent rights before applying for an order under section 199, and the court may on the application of the licensee make any order under that section that it thinks fit, having regard to the terms of the licence.
(7)In this section, licensee means a licensee under an exclusive performer’s rights licence.
Section 194K: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 29 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Heading:replaced, on 30 December 2018, by section 30 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)Consent for the purposes of this Part may be given in relation to a specific performance, a specified description of performances, or performances generally, and may relate to past or future performances.
(2)Where a right conferred by this Part passes to another person, any consent or waiver binding on the person previously entitled binds the person to whom the right passes in the same way as if the consent or waiver had been given by him or her.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 193 (UK)
Section 195 heading: replaced, on 30 December 2018, by section 31(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 195(2): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 31(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)An infringement of any of the rights conferred by this Part is actionable by the performer in whom the right is vested.
(2)An infringement of any of the rights conferred by this Part is also actionable, on behalf of the performer, by a person having recording rights, without any need to obtain the consent of the performer to the bringing of the proceedings, unless the performer expressly requires his or her consent to be obtained.
(3)In proceedings for infringement of any of the rights conferred by this Part, the relief that a court may grant includes—
(4)Where, in proceedings under this Part,—
the court may award such additional damages as the justice of the case may require.
(5)If, in proceedings for infringement of a performer’s property rights, it is proved or admitted that at the time of the infringement the defendant did not know, and had no reason to believe, that the acts complained of infringed the performer’s property rights, the plaintiff is not entitled to damages but, without prejudice to the award of any other remedy, is entitled to an account of profits.
Compare: Copyright Act 1968 s 248J (Aust)
Section 196(3)(b): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 32(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 196(5): inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 32(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
If any employee or agent of the Crown infringes a performer’s rights in a performance, and the infringement is committed with the authority of the Crown, civil proceedings in respect of the infringement lie against the Crown under the Crown Proceedings Act 1950 (subject to this Act).
Section 196A: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 33 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)Where a person has an illicit recording of a performance in that person’s possession, custody, or control in the course of a business,—
may apply to the court for an order that the illicit recording be delivered up to him or her or such other person as the court may direct.
(2)No order shall be made unless the court also makes, or it appears to the court that there are grounds for making, an order under section 202.
(3)A person to whom an illicit recording is delivered up in pursuance of an order under this section shall, if an order under section 202 is not made, retain the illicit recording pending the making of an order, or the decision not to make an order, under that section.
(4)Notwithstanding any rule of court, an order may be made pursuant to this section on an ex parte application where service of notice of the application would cause undue delay or other serious detriment to the applicant.
(5)Nothing in this section affects any other power of the court.
Heading:inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 34 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)This section applies to proceedings brought under this Act with respect to—
(2)If a person has previously been identified as the performer of a performance in accordance with section 170B(1)(c) or (d), it is presumed, until the contrary is proved,—
Section 197A: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 34 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)Every person commits an offence against this section who, without the consent of the performer,—
(ca)distributes otherwise than in the course of a business to such an extent as to affect prejudicially the performer; or
a specified recording.
(1A)In subsections (1) and (4), specified recording means—
(2)Every person commits an offence against this section who causes a recording that is, and that the person knows is, an illicit recording, to be—
(3)Every person commits an offence against this section who, otherwise than for that person’s private and domestic use, copies a recording—
(4)Every person who commits an offence against subsection (1), (2), or (3) is liable on conviction,—
(5)Where any person is convicted of an offence against this section in circumstances where that offence involves the making of profit or gain, that offence shall be deemed to have caused a loss of property for the purposes of section 32(1)(a) of the Sentencing Act 2002, and the provisions of that Act relating to the imposition of the sentence of reparation shall apply accordingly.
(6)Section 197A (which relates to presumptions) does not apply to proceedings for an offence against this section.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 198(1), (2), (3)(a), (5), (6) (UK)
Section 198(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 35(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 198(1)(ca): inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 35(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 198(1A): inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 35(3) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 198(2)(b): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 89 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 198(3)(c): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 35(4) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 198(4): replaced, on 30 December 2018, by section 35(5) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 198(5): amended, on 30 June 2002, by section 186 of the Sentencing Act 2002 (2002 No 9).
Section 198(6): inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 35(6) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)The court before which proceedings are brought against a person for an offence against section 198 may, if satisfied that, at the time of the defendant’s arrest or charge, the defendant had in his possession, custody, or control in the course of a business an illicit recording, order that the recording be delivered up to a person having performers’ rights in relation to the performance or to such other person as the court may direct.
(2)An order may be made under subsection (1) by the court of its own motion or on the application of the prosecution, and may be made whether or not the person is convicted of the offence, but shall not be made if it appears to the court unlikely that any order will be made under section 202 in the proceedings.
(3)A person to whom an illicit recording is delivered up pursuant to an order made under this section shall retain the recording pending the making of an order, or the decision not to make an order, under section 202.
(4)Section 197A (which relates to presumptions) applies in proceedings for an order under this section.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 199(1), (3), (5) (UK)
Section 199(4): inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 36 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)Every person commits an offence against this section who represents falsely that he or she is authorised by any person to give consent for the purposes of this Part in relation to a performance, unless he or she believes on reasonable grounds that he or she is entitled to do so.
(2)A person who commits an offence against this section is liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months or a fine not exceeding $10,000.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 201 (UK)
Section 200(2): amended, on 1 July 2013, by section 413 of the Criminal Procedure Act 2011 (2011 No 81).
Where any body corporate is convicted of an offence against section 198 or section 200, every director and every person concerned in the management of the body corporate shall be guilty of the offence if it is proved—
Compare: 1991 No 69 s 340
(1)In proceedings for an offence against section 198, whether by way of a hearing in the first instance or by way of appeal or otherwise, the court may receive an affidavit as evidence of—
(2)A party to the proceedings may apply to the court to require a person whose evidence has been given by affidavit to attend the proceedings for the purposes of cross-examination; and the court may make an order accordingly.
Section 201A: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 37 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)An application may be made to the court for an order that an illicit recording delivered up pursuant to an order made under section 197 or section 199 shall be—
(2)In considering what order (if any) should be made under subsection (1), the court shall have regard to—
(3)The court shall issue directions as to the service of notice on persons having an interest in the recording.
(4)Any person having an interest in the recording is entitled—
and an order made under subsection (1) shall not take effect until the end of the period within which notice of an appeal may be given or, if before the end of that period notice of appeal is duly given, until the final determination or abandonment of the proceedings on the appeal.
(5)Where there is more than 1 person interested in a recording, the court may direct that the recording be sold, or otherwise dealt with, and the proceeds divided, and shall make any other order as it thinks just.
(6)If the court decides that no order should be made under this section, the person in whose possession, custody, or control the recording was before being delivered up is entitled to its return.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 204 (UK)
[Repealed]
Section 203: repealed, on 14 October 1999, by section 4 of the Copyright Amendment Act 1999 (1999 No 124).
(1)On the recommendation of the Minister, the Governor-General may by Order in Council apply any provision or provisions of this Part to any entity specified in the order (whether a State, part of a State, a territory for whose international relations a State is responsible, a political union, an international organisation, or any other entity).
(2)An order—
(3)The Minister must not recommend the making of an order applying any provision of this Part to any entity unless satisfied that—
(4)If the Government of a State is responsible for the international relations of 1 or more territories, an order may apply a provision to—
(5)An order under this section is secondary legislation (see Part 3 of the Legislation Act 2019 for publication requirements).
| Legislation Act 2019 requirements for secondary legislation made under this section | ||
| Publication | PCO must publish it on the legislation website and notify LA19 s 69(1)(c) it in the Gazette | LA19 s 69(1)(c) |
| Presentation | The Minister must present it to the House of Representatives | LA19 s 114, Sch 1 cl 32(1)(a) |
| Disallowance | It may be disallowed by the House of Representatives | LA19 ss 115, 116 |
| This note is not part of the Act. | ||
Section 204: substituted, on 14 October 1999, by section 2(1) of the Copyright Amendment Act 1999 (1999 No 124).
Section 204(5): inserted, on 28 October 2021, by section 3 of the Secondary Legislation Act 2021 (2021 No 7).
The Tribunal constituted by section 30 of the Copyright Act 1962 and known as the Copyright Tribunal shall continue in being.
(1)The Tribunal consists of a chairperson and at least 2 other persons.
(2)The chairperson of the Tribunal—
(3)The other persons shall be appointed as members of the Tribunal by the Governor-General on the recommendation of the Minister.
(4)No person shall be deemed to be employed in the service of the Crown for the purposes of the Public Service Act 2020 by virtue merely of his or her appointment to the Tribunal.
(5)For the purposes of this Part, except for the reference in subsection (3), a reference to a member or members includes the chairperson.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 30(1), (2), (7)
Section 206(1): replaced, on 26 March 2015, by section 4(1) of the Copyright Amendment Act 2015 (2015 No 11).
Section 206(1): amended, on 14 November 2018, by section 8(1) of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
Section 206(2)(a): substituted, on 1 October 1995, by section 10(3) of the Department of Justice (Restructuring) Act 1995 (1995 No 39).
Section 206(3): amended, on 26 March 2015, by section 4(2) of the Copyright Amendment Act 2015 (2015 No 11).
Section 206(4): amended, on 7 August 2020, by section 135 of the Public Service Act 2020 (2020 No 40).
Section 206(5): inserted, on 14 November 2018, by section 8(2) of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
(1)Every member of the Tribunal shall hold office for a term not exceeding 5 years.
(2)Any member of the Tribunal may hold that office concurrently with any other office held by him or her and may from time to time be reappointed.
(3)A member of the Tribunal continues in office despite the expiry of his or her term of office until—
(3A)A member who continues in office for any period under subsection (3), unless he or she was removed from office, may act as a member during that period for the purpose of—
(3B)A member who has resigned, or whose successor is appointed or who will not be replaced (unless he or she was removed from office), may continue in office for the purpose of completing any proceedings that are partly or wholly heard.
(4)The powers of the Tribunal shall not be affected by any vacancy in its membership.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 30(3)–(6)
Section 207(3): replaced, on 14 November 2018, by section 9 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
Section 207(3A): inserted, on 14 November 2018, by section 9 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
Section 207(3B): inserted, on 14 November 2018, by section 9 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
(1)Any member of the Tribunal may at any time resign his or her office by delivering a notice in writing to that effect to the Minister.
(2)Any member of the Tribunal shall be deemed to have vacated his or her office if he or she dies or is, under the Insolvency Act 2006, adjudged bankrupt.
(3)Any member of the Tribunal may at any time be removed from office by the Governor-General for disability affecting performance of duty, neglect of duty, or misconduct, proved to the satisfaction of the Governor-General.
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 31, 32
Section 208(2): amended, on 3 December 2007, by section 445 of the Insolvency Act 2006 (2006 No 55).
(1)If the chairperson or a member of the Tribunal becomes incapable of acting by reason of illness, absence, or other sufficient cause, or if the chairperson or a member considers it is not proper or not desirable that he or she should adjudicate on a specified matter, the Governor-General, on the recommendation of the Minister, made, in the case of an acting chairperson, after consultation with the Minister of Justice, may appoint a suitable person as the acting chairperson or an acting member for the period or purpose stated in the appointment.
(2)No person may be appointed as the acting chairperson or an acting member unless he or she is eligible for appointment to the relevant position.
(3)The acting chairperson or acting member is, while acting in the position, to be treated as the chairperson or a member of the Tribunal.
(4)No appointment of an acting chairperson or acting member, no act done by an acting chairperson or acting member, and no act done by the Tribunal may be questioned in any proceedings on the ground that the occasion for the appointment had not arisen or had ceased.
Section 209: replaced, on 14 November 2018, by section 10 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
(1)The chairperson of the Tribunal may delegate any of the chairperson’s functions, duties, and powers to a member of the Tribunal who holds the qualifications set out in section 206(2)(b) and the chairperson is satisfied has the necessary capability, skills, and experience to perform or exercise those functions, duties, and powers.
(2)A delegation—
(3)A person to whom any functions, duties, or powers are delegated may perform or exercise them in the same manner and with the same effect as if they had been conferred directly by this Act and not by delegation.
(4)A person who appears to act under a delegation is presumed to be acting in accordance with its terms in the absence of evidence to the contrary.
(5)A person to whom any functions, duties, or powers are delegated must be paid remuneration and expenses (if any) determined in accordance with section 210 for work undertaken in that capacity.
Section 209A: inserted, on 29 October 2019, by section 11 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
(1)The Tribunal is hereby declared to be a statutory board within the meaning of the Fees and Travelling Allowances Act 1951.
(2)There shall be paid to members of the Tribunal, out of money appropriated by Parliament for the purpose, remuneration by way of fees, salary, or allowances and travelling allowances and expenses in accordance with the Fees and Travelling Allowances Act 1951, and the provisions of that Act shall apply accordingly.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 35
The Tribunal shall have such functions as are conferred on it by this Act or any other enactment.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 37
(1)The chairperson of the Tribunal is responsible for making such arrangements as are practicable to ensure that he or she and each member performs his or her functions—
(2)The Ministry of Justice must provide the resources and administrative support necessary to enable the Tribunal to perform its functions.
Section 211A: inserted, on 14 November 2018, by section 12 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
(1)The operator of the licensing scheme or the proposed licensing scheme shall be a party to any proceedings under section 149 or section 150 or section 151 or section 153 or section 154 or section 157 or section 158 or section 159.
(2)The Tribunal may direct that an organisation or person be added as a party to any proceedings before the Tribunal under this Act where the Tribunal is satisfied that the organisation or person has a substantial interest in the matter in dispute and either—
(3)The Attorney-General, if in his or her opinion the public interest is or may be involved, may, on giving such notice to other parties as the Tribunal may direct, appear and be heard, or present submissions in writing on any proceedings before the Tribunal.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 42
(1)The Tribunal shall fix a time and place for the hearing of proceedings and shall cause notice to be given to the parties of the time and place so fixed.
(2)No sitting of the Tribunal shall take place, except for the purposes of interlocutory or other ancillary matters, unless at least 3 members are present.
(3)Every sitting of the Tribunal shall be held in such place as the Tribunal deems convenient.
(4)Every sitting of the Tribunal shall be held in public unless the Tribunal in any particular case, having regard to the interests of the parties and of all other persons concerned, considers that the sitting or any part of it should be held in private.
(5)The Tribunal may make an order prohibiting the publication of any report or description of the proceedings or of any part of the proceedings.
(6)Every person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding $3,000 who acts in contravention of any order made by the Tribunal under subsection (5).
(7)Any sitting of the Tribunal may be adjourned from time to time and from place to place.
(8)Despite anything in this Act to the contrary and except as provided in section 122L, the Tribunal may determine a proceeding on the papers if the Tribunal considers it appropriate.
(9)Before doing so, the Tribunal must give the parties a reasonable opportunity to comment on whether the proceeding should be dealt with in that manner.
(10)The hearing of a matter or any part of it may be conducted by telephone, audiovisual link, or other remote access facility if the chairperson or the Tribunal considers it appropriate and the necessary facilities are available.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 43(1)–(4)
Section 213 heading: replaced, on 14 November 2018, by section 13(1) of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
Section 213(2): amended, on 1 September 2011, by section 9 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 213(6): amended, on 1 July 2013, by section 413 of the Criminal Procedure Act 2011 (2011 No 81).
Section 213(8): inserted, on 14 November 2018, by section 13(2) of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
Section 213(9): inserted, on 14 November 2018, by section 13(2) of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
Section 213(10): inserted, on 14 November 2018, by section 13(2) of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
(1)Any party to proceedings before the Tribunal may appear personally or by the party’s barrister, solicitor, or agent.
(2)The Tribunal may appoint a barrister or solicitor to appear and be heard in proceedings as counsel assisting the Tribunal.
(3)The decision of the majority of members shall be the decision of the Tribunal.
(3A)If the members are equally divided in opinion, the decision of the chairperson is the decision of the Tribunal.
(4)Every decision of the Tribunal shall be in writing and shall state the reasons for the decision.
(5)The Tribunal may regulate its procedures as it sees fit, subject to this Act, any regulations made under it, and any practice notes issued under section 224A.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 43(5)–(8)
Section 214(3A): inserted, on 14 November 2018, by section 14(1) of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
Section 214(5): replaced, on 14 November 2018, by section 14(2) of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
(1)The Tribunal may strike out, in whole or in part, a proceeding if satisfied that it—
(2)If a party is neither present nor represented at the hearing of a proceeding, the Tribunal may,—
Section 214A: inserted, on 14 November 2018, by section 15 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
(1)The Tribunal may receive as evidence any statement, document, information, or matter that may in its opinion assist it to deal effectively with the matters before it, whether or not the same would be admissible in a court of law.
(2)The Tribunal may take evidence on oath, and for that purpose any member or officer of the Tribunal may administer an oath.
(3)The Tribunal may permit a person appearing as a witness before it to give evidence by tendering a written statement and, if the Tribunal thinks fit, verifying it by oath.
(4)Subject to subsections (1) to (3), the Evidence Act 2006 applies to the Tribunal in the same manner as if the Tribunal were a court within the meaning of that Act.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 44; 1993 No 82 s 106
Section 215(4): amended, on 1 August 2007, by section 216 of the Evidence Act 2006 (2006 No 69).
(1)The Tribunal may of its own motion, or on the application of any party to the proceedings, issue a witness summons to any person requiring that person to attend before the Tribunal to give evidence at the hearing of the proceedings.
(2)The witness summons shall state—
(3)The power to issue a witness summons may be exercised by the Tribunal or the chairperson, or by any officer of the Tribunal purporting to act by the direction or with the authority of the Tribunal or the chairperson.
Compare: 1993 No 82 s 109
(1)A witness summons may be served—
(2)The summons shall,—
(3)A summons sent to a person in accordance with subsection (1)(b) must be treated as served on the person at the time when it would have been delivered in the ordinary course of business for the service it was sent by.
(4)In the absence of proof to the contrary, a summons emailed to a person in accordance with subsection (1)(c) must be treated as served on the person on the second working day after the date on which it is emailed, and, in proving that the summons was emailed, it is sufficient to prove that the summons was properly addressed and sent to the email address.
Compare: 1993 No 82 s 110
Section 217(1)(a): replaced, on 14 November 2018, by section 16 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
Section 217(1)(b): replaced, on 16 December 2017, by section 57(1) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
Section 217(1)(c): inserted, on 16 December 2017, by section 57(1) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
Section 217(2)(b): amended, on 16 December 2017, by section 57(2) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
Section 217(3): replaced, on 16 December 2017, by section 57(3) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
Section 217(4): inserted, on 16 December 2017, by section 57(3) of the Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50).
(1)Every witness attending before the Tribunal to give evidence pursuant to a summons shall be entitled to be paid witnesses’ fees, allowances, and travelling expenses according to the scales for the time being prescribed by regulations made under the Criminal Procedure Act 2011, and those regulations shall apply accordingly.
(2)On each occasion on which the Tribunal issues a summons under section 216, the Tribunal, or the person exercising the power of the Tribunal under subsection (3) of that section, shall fix an amount that, on the service of the summons, or at some other reasonable time before the date on which the witness is required to attend, shall be paid or tendered to the witness.
(3)The amount fixed under subsection (2) shall be the estimated amount of the allowances and travelling expenses to which, in the opinion of the Tribunal or person, the witness will be entitled according to the prescribed scales if the witness attends at the time and place specified in the summons.
(4)Where a party to the proceedings has requested the issue of the witness summons, the fees, allowances, and travelling expenses payable to the witness shall be paid by that party.
(5)Where the Tribunal has of its own motion issued the witness summons, the Tribunal may direct that the amount of those fees, allowances, and travelling expenses—
Compare: 1993 No 82 s 111
Section 218(1): amended, on 1 July 2013, by section 413 of the Criminal Procedure Act 2011 (2011 No 81).
(1)Witnesses appearing before the Tribunal shall have the same privileges and immunities as witnesses have in proceedings in the District Court.
(2)Counsel and agents appearing before the Tribunal shall have the same privileges and immunities as counsel have in proceedings in the District Court.
(3)The Tribunal, the chairperson, and the members are not personally liable for any act done or omitted to be done by the Tribunal, the chairperson, or any member in good faith in the performance or exercise, or intended performance or exercise, of their functions, duties, or powers under this Act.
Compare: 1993 No 82 s 112
Section 219(1): amended, on 1 March 2017, by section 261 of the District Court Act 2016 (2016 No 49).
Section 219(2): amended, on 1 March 2017, by section 261 of the District Court Act 2016 (2016 No 49).
Section 219(3): inserted, on 14 November 2018, by section 17 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
(1)Every person commits an offence who, after being summoned to attend to give evidence before the Tribunal or to produce to the Tribunal any papers, documents, records, or things, without sufficient cause,—
(2)Every person who commits an offence against subsection (1) is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding $1,500.
(3)No person summoned to attend before the Tribunal shall be convicted of an offence against subsection (1) unless there was tendered or paid to that person travelling expenses in accordance with section 218.
Compare: 1993 No 82 s 113
Section 220(2): amended, on 1 July 2013, by section 413 of the Criminal Procedure Act 2011 (2011 No 81).
(1)Every person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding $1,000 who—
(2)A member of the Tribunal may order the exclusion from a sitting of the Tribunal of any person whose behaviour, in that member’s opinion, constitutes an offence against subsection (1), whether or not such person is charged with the offence; and any constable or any officer of the Tribunal may take such steps as are reasonably necessary to enforce such an exclusion.
Section 221(1): amended, on 1 July 2013, by section 413 of the Criminal Procedure Act 2011 (2011 No 81).
Section 221(1)(a): amended, on 14 November 2018, by section 18(1) of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
Section 221(2): amended, on 14 November 2018, by section 18(2) of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
Section 221(2): amended, on 1 October 2008, pursuant to section 116(a)(ii) of the Policing Act 2008 (2008 No 72).
(1)The Tribunal, in any proceedings before it under this Act, may make such order as to costs as it thinks fit.
(2)Any such order as to costs may be filed in the District Court and may be enforced as a judgment of that court.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 46
Section 222(2): amended, on 1 March 2017, by section 261 of the District Court Act 2016 (2016 No 49).
(1)This section applies where the Tribunal makes an order under Part 8 for the payment of an amount of money (including money required to be repaid, or further money required to be paid, in respect of charges already paid).
(2)The Tribunal’s order may include an award of interest on the whole or part of the money, payable for the period, ending not later than the date that the money is paid, that the Tribunal thinks appropriate, as compensation for delay in payment of the money.
(3)Interest awarded under this section must be calculated in accordance with (or on a basis that ensures it does not exceed interest calculated in accordance with) Schedule 2 of the Interest on Money Claims Act 2016.
Section 222A: inserted, on 1 January 2018, by section 4 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2016 (2016 No 59).
(1)The Tribunal may, at any time, before or during the hearing or before delivering its decision, on the application of any party to the proceedings or of its own motion, state a case for the opinion of the High Court on any question of law arising in any proceedings before the Tribunal.
(2)The Tribunal shall give notice to the parties to the proceedings of the Tribunal’s intention to state a case under this section, specifying the registry of the High Court in which the case is to be filed.
(3)Except where the Tribunal intends to state the case of its own motion, the question shall be in the form of a special case to be drawn up by the parties to the proceedings, and, if the parties do not agree, to be settled by the Tribunal.
(4)Where the Tribunal intends to state a case of its own motion, it shall itself state and sign a case setting forth the facts and questions of law arising for the determination of the High Court.
(5)Every case stated for the High Court under this section shall be dealt with in accordance with rules of court.
(6)The High Court shall hear and determine any question submitted to it under this section, and shall remit the case with its opinion to the Tribunal.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 47; 1993 No 82 s 122
(1)Where any party to any proceedings before the Tribunal under this Act is dissatisfied with any determination of the Tribunal as being erroneous in point of law, that party may appeal to the High Court on that question of law.
(2)Every appeal under this section shall be dealt with in accordance with rules of court.
Compare: 1993 No 94 s 58
Heading:inserted, on 14 November 2018, by section 19 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
(1)The chairperson of the Tribunal may issue practice notes for any type of proceedings dealt with by the Tribunal as he or she thinks fit.
(2)The practice notes must not be inconsistent with this Act or any regulations made under it, and are for the guidance of other members of the Tribunal, officers of the Tribunal, and parties before the Tribunal.
Section 224A: inserted, on 14 November 2018, by section 19 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
The following information must be published on an Internet site maintained by or on behalf of the chief executive of the Ministry of Justice:
Section 224B: inserted, on 29 October 2019, by section 20 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
(1)Every final written decision of the Tribunal must be published on an Internet site as soon as practicable unless there is good reason not to publish it.
(2)A final written decision may be published in part if there is good reason for not publishing the full decision.
(3)Subsections (1) and (2) are subject to section 213(5).
(4)Good reason not to publish a decision, or part of it, includes the following:
(5)In this section, final written decision means a written decision that determines, or substantially determines, the outcome of proceedings in the Tribunal and is either of the following:
Section 224C: inserted, on 29 October 2019, by section 20 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
(1)Nothing in this Act affects—
(2)Subject to subsection (1), no copyright or right in the nature of copyright shall exist otherwise than under this Act or some other enactment in that behalf.
(3)Nothing in this Act affects any rule of law preventing or restricting the enforcement of copyright, on grounds of public interest or otherwise.
(4)Nothing in this Act affects any right of action or other remedy, whether civil or criminal, available otherwise than under this Act in respect of acts infringing any of the rights conferred by Part 4.
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 5, 67; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 171 (UK)
Heading:substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 90 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
In sections 226A to 226E, unless the context otherwise requires,— issuer of the TPM work or issuer of a TPM work means—
permitted act means an act that—
specified performers’ rights means the rights conferred by section 172, or subpart 4 of Part 9, in respect of a recording that is a sound recording and a TPM work
TPM or technological protection measure—
TPM circumvention device means a device or means that—
TPM work means a copyright work that is protected by a technological protection measure.
Section 226: substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 90 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 226 heading: replaced, on 30 December 2018, by section 37A(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 226 issuer of the TPM work or issuer of a TPM work: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 37A(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 226 permitted act: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 37A(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 226 specified performers’ rights: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 37A(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A person (A) must not make, import, sell, distribute, let for hire, offer or expose for sale or hire, or advertise for sale or hire, a TPM circumvention device that applies to a technological protection measure if A knows or has reason to believe that it will, or is likely to, be used to infringe copyright in a TPM work.
(2)A person (A) must not provide a service to another person (B) if—
(3)A person (A) must not publish information enabling or assisting another person to circumvent a technological protection measure if A intends that the information will be used to infringe copyright in a TPM work.
Section 226A: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 90 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)[Repealed]
(2)The issuer of the TPM work has the same rights and remedies against a person who contravenes section 226A as a copyright owner has in respect of an infringement of copyright.
(3)The issuer of the TPM work has the same rights under section 122 (order for delivery up in civil proceedings) or 132 (order for delivery up in criminal proceedings) in relation to a TPM circumvention device as a copyright owner has in relation to an infringing copy.
(4)Sections 126 to 129 and 197A (which relate to certain presumptions) apply in relation to proceedings under this section.
(5)Section 134 (order as to disposal of infringing copy or other object) applies, with all necessary modifications, in relation to the disposal of anything that is delivered up under subsection (3).
(6)A performer (A) must be treated as an issuer of the TPM work for the purposes of this section if—
Section 226B: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 90 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 226B(1): repealed, on 30 December 2018, by section 40(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 226B(2): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 40(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 226B(4): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 40(5) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 226B(6): inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 40(6) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A person (A) commits an offence who, in the course of business, makes, , ,, imports, sells, distributes, lets for hire, offers or exposes for sale or hire, or advertises for sale or hire, a TPM circumvention device that applies to a technological protection measure if A knows that it will, or is likely to, be used to infringe copyright in a TPM work.
(2)A person (A) commits an offence who, in the course of business, provides a service to another person (B) if—
(3)A person (A) commits an offence who, in the course of business, publishes information enabling or assisting another person to circumvent a technological protection measure if A intends that the information will be used to infringe copyright in a TPM work.
(4)A person who commits an offence under this section is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding $150,000 or a term of imprisonment not exceeding 5 years or both.
Section 226C: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 90 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 226C(4): amended, on 1 July 2013, by section 413 of the Criminal Procedure Act 2011 (2011 No 81).
(1)The rights that the issuer of a TPM work has under section 226B do not prevent or restrict the exercise of a permitted act.
(2)The rights that the issuer of a TPM work has under section 226B do not prevent or restrict the making, importation, sale, or letting for hire of a TPM circumvention device to enable—
(3)In this section and in section 226E, qualified person means—
(4)A qualified person must not be supplied with a TPM circumvention device on behalf of a user unless the qualified person has first made a declaration to the supplier in the prescribed form.
(5)In this section,—
archive has the same meaning as in section 50(1)
archivist includes a person acting on behalf of the archivist
encryption technology means the scrambling and descrambling of information using mathematical formulae or algorithms
librarian includes a person acting on behalf of the librarian
prescribed library has the same meaning as in section 50(1).
(6)In this section and in section 226E, encryption research means identifying and analysing flaws and vulnerabilities of encryption technology.
(7)An order under subsection (3)(d) is secondary legislation (see Part 3 of the Legislation Act 2019 for publication requirements).
| Legislation Act 2019 requirements for secondary legislation made under this section | ||
| Publication | PCO must publish it on the legislation website and notify LA19 s 69(1)(c) it in the Gazette | LA19 s 69(1)(c) |
| Presentation | The Minister must present it to the House of Representatives | LA19 s 114, Sch 1 cl 32(1)(a) |
| Disallowance | It may be disallowed by the House of Representatives | LA19 ss 115, 116 |
| This note is not part of the Act. | ||
Section 226D: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 90 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 226D(2)(a): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 37B of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 226D(7): inserted, on 28 October 2021, by section 3 of the Secondary Legislation Act 2021 (2021 No 7).
(1)Nothing in this Act prevents any person from using a TPM circumvention device to exercise a permitted act.
(2)The user of a TPM work who wishes to exercise a permitted act but cannot practically do so because of a TPM may do either or both of the following:
(3)Nothing in this Act prevents any person from using a TPM circumvention device to undertake encryption research if that research is a permitted act and if that person—
(4)A qualified person who exercises a permitted act on behalf of the user of a TPM work must not charge the user more than a sum consisting of the total of the cost of the provision of the service and a reasonable contribution to the qualified person’s general expenses.
Section 226E: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 90 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 226E(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 37C(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 226E(2): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 37C(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 226E(2)(a): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 37C(3) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 226E(2)(b): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 37C(3) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 226E(3): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 37C(4) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 226E(3)(b)(i): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 37C(5) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Heading:inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 90 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
In sections 226G, 226H, and 226J, CMI or copyright management information means information attached to, or appearing in connection with communicating or making available, a copy of a copyright work that—
Section 226F: replaced, on 30 December 2018, by section 37D of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A person (A) must not remove or modify any copyright management information attached to, or appearing in connection with communicating or making available, a copy of a work.
(2)However, subsection (1) does not apply if—
Section 226G: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 90 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 226G(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 37E of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A person (A) must not, in the course of business, make, import, sell, let for hire, offer or expose for sale or hire, or advertise for sale or hire, a copy of a work if any copyright management information attached to, or appearing in connection with communicating or making available, the copy has been removed or modified without the authority of the copyright owner or the exclusive licensee.
(2)However, subsection (1) does not apply if—
Section 226H: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 90 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 226H(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 37F of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 226H(2)(c): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 37F of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A copyright owner or licensee of a work has the same rights in relation to a contravention of section 226G or 226H as a copyright owner has in respect of an infringement of copyright.
(2)If the copyright management information is or includes information that identifies an author, a director, or a performer (or is a number or code that represents information that identifies that person), the author, director, or performer (or a person entitled to exercise that person’s rights under Part 4 or 9) has the same rights and remedies in relation to a contravention of either of sections 226G and 226H as an author, a director, or a performer has in respect of an infringement of the rights conferred by Part 4 or 9.
(3)Subsection (2) does not limit subsection (1).
Section 226I: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 90 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 226I(2): inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 37G of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Section 226I(3): inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 37G of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A person (A) who contravenes section 226H commits an offence if—
(2)A person who commits an offence under subsection (1) is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding $150,000 or a term of imprisonment not exceeding 5 years or both.
Section 226J: inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 90 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 226J(2): amended, on 1 July 2013, by section 413 of the Criminal Procedure Act 2011 (2011 No 81).
(1)Every person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding $5,000 who, with intent to avoid payment of any charge applicable to the reception of a programme included in a communication work provided from a place in New Zealand, receives such a programme.
(2)Where any body corporate is convicted of an offence against this section, every director and every person concerned in the management of the body corporate shall be guilty of the offence if it is proved—
Compare: 1991 No 69 s 340; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 297 (UK)
Section 227(1): amended, on 1 July 2013, by section 413 of the Criminal Procedure Act 2011 (2011 No 81).
Section 227(1): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 91 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)A person who—
is entitled to the rights and remedies in subsections (2) and (3).
(2)A person to whom subsection (1) applies—
(3)The person referred to in subsection (2) is a person who—
(4)In section 121(1) as it applies to proceedings for infringement of the rights conferred by this section, the reference to the defendant not knowing or having reason to believe that copyright existed in the work shall be construed as a reference to not knowing or having reason to believe that the acts complained of infringed the rights conferred by this section.
(5)Section 134 applies, with all necessary modifications, in relation to the disposal of anything delivered up under subsection (2)(b).
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 298 (UK)
Section 228(1)(a): amended, on 31 October 2008, pursuant to section 92 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)The Governor-General may from time to time, by Order in Council,—
(2)No such order shall be made unless it appears to the Governor-General that provision has been or will be made under the laws of that country or territory giving adequate protection to persons making charges for programmes included in communication works provided from New Zealand or, as the case may be, for encrypted transmissions sent from New Zealand.
(3)Where sections 227 and 228 apply in relation to a communication work, they also apply to any service run for the person providing that service, or a person providing programmes for that service, where the service so run consists wholly or mainly in the sending by means of a telecommunications system of sounds or visual images, or both.
(4)An order under this section is secondary legislation (see Part 3 of the Legislation Act 2019 for publication requirements).
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 299 (UK)
| Legislation Act 2019 requirements for secondary legislation made under this section | ||
| Publication | PCO must publish it on the legislation website and notify LA19 s 69(1)(c) it in the Gazette | LA19 s 69(1)(c) |
| Presentation | The Minister must present it to the House of Representatives | LA19 s 114, Sch 1 cl 32(1)(a) |
| Disallowance | It may be disallowed by the House of Representatives | LA19 ss 115, 116 |
| This note is not part of the Act. | ||
Section 229(2): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 93(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 229(3): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 93(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 229(4): inserted, on 28 October 2021, by section 3 of the Secondary Legislation Act 2021 (2021 No 7).
(1)Subject to subsection (2), the provisions of this Act, other than the provisions of Part 9, shall—
until the close of 31 December 1995 or, in relation to any particular convention country, the coming into force in respect of that convention country of an Order in Council made under section 232, whichever is the earlier.
(2)For the avoidance of doubt, it is hereby declared that subsection (1) applies, in relation to a state of affairs or an action referred to in that subsection as existing or taking place in a convention country, whether or not the country in which the state of affairs existed or the action was taken was, at the time the state of affairs existed or the action was taken, a convention country.
(3)No provision of this Act shall apply, pursuant to subsection (1), to a work made before the commencement of this Act unless—
Section 230(1)(d): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 94 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
(1)This section applies in any case where—
(2)Where, in any case to which subsection (1) applies, a person incurred any expenditure or liability relating to an act that, at the time the act was done, was not an act restricted by copyright in the work, the person does not do an act restricted by copyright by doing, or continuing to do, that act in respect of the work when copyright exists in the work.
(3)Notwithstanding subsection (2), an act that under that subsection is not an act restricted by copyright when copyright exists in the work may become an act restricted by copyright if the owner of the copyright or his or her exclusive licensee (if any) pays the person such compensation for the person’s expenditure or liability as may be agreed upon or, in default of agreement, as shall be determined by arbitration in accordance with the provisions of the Arbitration Act 1908.
(1)On the recommendation of the Minister, the Governor-General may by Order in Council apply any provision or provisions of this Act (other than a provision of Part 9) to any entity specified in the order (whether a State, part of a State, a territory for whose international relations a State is responsible, a political union, an international organisation, or any other entity).
(2)To the extent that the nature of the entity permits, an order may apply a provision to an entity so that it has all or any of the following effects:
(3)An order—
(4)The Minister must not recommend the making of an order applying any provision of this Act to any entity unless satisfied that—
(5)If the Government of a State is responsible for the international relations of 1 or more territories, an order may apply a provision to—
(6)If—
the authorised person must be treated as if he or she were the author of the work for the purposes of the provision.
(7)An order under this section is secondary legislation (see Part 3 of the Legislation Act 2019 for publication requirements).
| Legislation Act 2019 requirements for secondary legislation made under this section | ||
| Publication | PCO must publish it on the legislation website and notify LA19 s 69(1)(c) it in the Gazette | LA19 s 69(1)(c) |
| Presentation | The Minister must present it to the House of Representatives | LA19 s 114, Sch 1 cl 32(1)(a) |
| Disallowance | It may be disallowed by the House of Representatives | LA19 ss 115, 116 |
| This note is not part of the Act. | ||
Section 232: substituted, on 14 October 1999, by section 3(1) of the Copyright Amendment Act 1999 (1999 No 124).
Section 232(2)(d): substituted, on 31 October 2008, by section 95 of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 232(7): inserted, on 28 October 2021, by section 3 of the Secondary Legislation Act 2021 (2021 No 7).
(1)Whenever it appears to the Governor-General that the law of a country, other than a convention country, fails to give adequate protection to copyright in New Zealand works, or to 1 or more classes of such works, the GovernorGeneral may by Order in Council make provision in accordance with this section restricting the rights conferred by this Act in relation to that country.
(2)An Order in Council made under this section shall designate the country concerned and provide that, for the purposes specified in the order, works first published after a date specified in the order shall not be treated as qualifying for copyright by virtue of such publication if at that time the authors are—
and the order may make such provision for all purposes of this Act or for such purposes as are specified in the order, and either generally or in relation to such classes of cases as are specified in the order, having regard to the nature and extent of the failure referred to in subsection (1).
(3)An Order in Council under this section may be so made as to apply generally to a country, or to any territories for whose international relations the Government of that country is responsible, or to the country exclusive of all or any such territories.
(4)In this section,—
New Zealand works means works of which the author was at the material time a person to whom section 18 applied
works means literary, dramatic, musical, and artistic works, sound recordings, and films.
(5)An order under this section is secondary legislation (see Part 3 of the Legislation Act 2019 for publication requirements).
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 51; Copyright Act 1968 s 185 (Aust); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 s 160 (UK)
| Legislation Act 2019 requirements for secondary legislation made under this section | ||
| Publication | PCO must publish it on the legislation website and notify LA19 s 69(1)(c) it in the Gazette | LA19 s 69(1)(c) |
| Presentation | The Minister must present it to the House of Representatives | LA19 s 114, Sch 1 cl 32(1)(a) |
| Disallowance | It may be disallowed by the House of Representatives | LA19 ss 115, 116 |
| This note is not part of the Act. | ||
Section 233(5): inserted, on 28 October 2021, by section 3 of the Secondary Legislation Act 2021 (2021 No 7).
The Governor-General may from time to time, by Order in Council, make regulations for all or any of the following purposes:
(ea)prescribing the form of a notice of infringement for the purposes of section 92D:
(eb)prescribing the form, content, procedures, requirements, and any other matters relating to infringement notices:
(ec)prescribing the form of notice for challenging an infringement notice:
(ed)prescribing the fee payable by rights owners for applications to the Tribunal under section 122J:
(ee)prescribing the practices and procedures of the Tribunal in relation to determining applications under section 122J:
(ef)prescribing the sum, or a method or methods of calculating the sum, that the Tribunal may order an account holder to pay under section 122O:
(eg)prescribing any matters necessary or desirable in relation to an order, or an application for an order, under section 122P:
(eh)prescribing the rate or rates, or a method or methods for calculating the rate or rates, for the fees that may be charged by IPAPs to rights owners under section 122U:
to give security or an indemnity, or both, to such persons, of such amount, and on such terms and conditions as may be determined by the chief executive of the New Zealand Customs Service:
without the consent of the owner of the copyright in the work:
(qa)prescribing fees in relation to licensing scheme disputes before the Tribunal:
Compare: 1962 No 33 ss 29(4), (5), 66
Section 234(d): replaced, on 4 January 2020, by section 7 of the Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43).
Section 234(e): amended, on 31 October 2008, by section 96(1) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 234(ea): inserted, on 31 October 2008, by section 96(2) of the Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27).
Section 234(eb): inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 234(ec): inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 234(ed): inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 234(ee): inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 234(ef): inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 234(eg): inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 234(eh): inserted, on 1 September 2011, by section 10 of the Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11).
Section 234(i): amended, on 1 October 1996, by section 289(1) of the Customs and Excise Act 1996 (1996 No 27).
Section 234(m): substituted, on 16 September 2011, by section 14 of the Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72).
Section 234(q): amended, on 1 July 2013, by section 413 of the Criminal Procedure Act 2011 (2011 No 81).
Section 234(qa): inserted, on 14 November 2018, by section 21 of the Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51).
The transitional provisions in Schedule 1 shall have effect for the purposes of this Act.
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 68(1)
(1)The enactments specified in Schedule 2 are hereby amended in the manner indicated in that schedule.
(2)The enactments specified in Schedule 3 are hereby repealed.
(3)The regulations specified in Schedule 4 are hereby revoked.
s 235
Schedule 1 Part 1 heading: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 44(1) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)In this Part, unless the context otherwise requires,—
the 1913 Act means the Copyright Act 1913
the 1962 Act means the Copyright Act 1962
the 1985 Amendment means the Copyright Amendment Act 1985
the new copyright provisions means the provisions of this Act
work means,—
(2)References in this Part to commencement, without more, are to the date on which the new copyright provisions come into force.
(3)For the purposes of this Part, a work of which the making extended over a period shall be taken to have been made when its making was completed.
(4)Unless the context otherwise requires, provisions of the 1913 Act or the 1962 Act referred to in this Part shall be taken as continuing in force for the purposes of this schedule, notwithstanding the repeal of the 1913 Act and the 1962 Act.
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 47(2); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 paras 1, 2(1) (UK)
Schedule 1 clause 1(1): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 44(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Schedule 1 clause 1(2): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 44(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Schedule 1 clause 1(3): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 44(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Schedule 1 clause 1(4): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 44(2) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)A reference in an enactment, instrument, or other document to copyright that, apart from this Act, would be construed as referring to copyright under the 1962 Act or any corresponding earlier enactment, shall be construed, so far as may be required for continuing its effect, as being, or as the case may require including, a reference to copyright under this Act.
(2)A reference in an enactment, instrument, or other document to a work in which copyright exists that, apart from this Act, would be construed as referring to a work in which copyright exists under the 1962 Act or any corresponding earlier enactment, shall be construed, so far as may be required for continuing its effect, as being, or as the case may require including, a reference to a work in which copyright exists under this Act.
(3)Express or implied references in this Act or any other enactment, instrument, or document to any of the new copyright provisions shall, so far as the context permits, be construed as including, in relation to times, circumstances, and purposes before commencement, a reference to corresponding earlier provisions.
(4)An express or implied reference in an instrument or other document to a provision repealed by this Act shall be construed, so far as may be required for continuing its effect, as a reference to the corresponding provision of this Act.
(5)The provisions of this clause have effect subject to any specific transitional and savings provision and to any express amendment made by this Act.
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 46(1)(a), (b); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 4(2), (4)–(6) (UK)
(1)Copyright exists under the new copyright provisions in any work in which copyright existed immediately before commencement.
(2)For the purposes of subclause (1), a work in which copyright existed immediately before commencement includes a work in which a right was conferred by section 32 of the 1913 Act in substitution for a right existing immediately before the commencement of the 1913 Act.
(3)Where copyright exists under the new copyright provisions in a work in which copyright existed immediately before commencement, the copyright in that work under the new provisions is subject to any modifications made by the provisions of this Part.
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 38(2); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 paras 2(2)(a), 5(1) (UK)
Schedule 1 clause 3(3): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 44(3) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)The new copyright provisions—
(2)For the purposes of subclause (1), a work in which copyright existed immediately before commencement includes a work in which a right was conferred by section 32 of the 1913 Act in substitution for a right existing immediately before the commencement of the 1913 Act.
(3)Where the new copyright provisions apply to a work in which copyright existed immediately before commencement, the new copyright provisions are subject, in their application to that work, to any modifications made by the provisions of this Part.
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cls 38(2), 47(1); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 paras 3, 35 (UK)
Schedule 1 clause 4(3): amended, on 30 December 2018, by section 44(3) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)Subject to subclause (2), a work made before commencement may qualify for copyright after commencement—
(2)A work first published in New Zealand before 1 April 1963 does not qualify for copyright under section 19(1)(a) if the work was published elsewhere more than 14 days before the publication in New Zealand.
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 2(1); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 5(2) (UK)
(1)No copyright exists, under the new copyright provisions, in the following works:
(2)Section 28 does not confer copyright on a work that was, before 1 April 1963, made by an officer or employee of, or published by, an international organisation to which that section applies.
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cls 14, 17, 20, 33; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 paras 7(1), 9 (UK)
The question of authorship of a work made before commencement shall be determined in accordance with—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 10 (UK)
(1)Subsections (2) and (3) of section 9 do not apply in relation to a copy of a computer program, sound recording, or film acquired by any person before commencement for the purpose of renting the copy to the public.
(2)In subclause (1),—
film includes a film that was an original dramatic work within the meaning of the 1913 Act
sound recording includes a contrivance of the kind to which section 25 of the 1913 Act applied.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 paras 2(2)(b), 14(2) (UK)
Section 10(2) applies only where the construction of the building began after commencement.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 45 (UK)
For the purposes of section 12, the question of whether the making of an object constituted an infringement of copyright, or would have constituted an infringement of copyright had the object been made in New Zealand, shall be determined,—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 14(3) (UK)
(1)In this clause,—
cinematograph film or film has the meaning that cinematograph film had in the 1962 Act
sound recording has the meaning it has in this Act.
(2)A soundtrack associated with a cinematograph film, being a soundtrack to which the 1962 Act applied before commencement, shall be treated for the purposes of the new copyright provisions not as part of the film, but as a sound recording.
(3)The following provisions apply to a soundtrack treated as a sound recording under subclause (2):
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 8 (UK)
(1)The new copyright provisions have effect in relation to a film—
as if it were an original dramatic work within the meaning of the new copyright provisions, except that the person who was the author of the work for the purposes of the 1913 Act shall be taken to be the author for the purposes of the new copyright provisions.
(2)The new copyright provisions in relation to photographs apply in relation to photographs forming part of a film—
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cls 15, 16; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 7(2), (3) (UK)
(1)Where—
the acts restricted by the copyright under the new copyright provisions shall be treated as not including—
(2)Where—
the acts restricted by the copyright under the new copyright provisions shall be treated as consisting only of the acts of—
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cls 38, 40; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 17 (UK)
The question of first ownership of copyright in a work made before commencement shall be determined in accordance with the law in force at the time the work was made.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 11(1) (UK)
Where a literary work—
the ownership of copyright in the work, under section 8(1)(b) of the 1913 Act, by the person by whom the author was employed shall be subject to a right in the author to restrain the publication of the work otherwise than as part of a newspaper, magazine, or similar periodical (being the right referred to in paragraph (b) of the proviso to section 8(1) of the 1913 Act).
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 7(2)
Where a literary work—
any copyright in that work under the new copyright provisions is subject to the right of the author to publish the essay, article, or portion in a separate form at the end of the period of 28 years from its first publication in a review, magazine, or other periodical or work of a like nature (being the right referred to in section 18 of the Copyright Act 1842 (UK)).
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 41; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 18 (UK)
(1)In this clause,—
dramatic work includes a film of the kind to which the definition of dramatic work in section 2(1) of the 1913 Act applied
generated by computer, in relation to a work, means that the work is generated by computer in circumstances such that there is no human author of the work
sound recording includes a contrivance of the kind to which section 25 of the 1913 Act applied.
(2)In relation to—
(3)If, in any case to which subclause (2)(d)(ii) applies, the identity of the author becomes known before the date on which the copyright would otherwise have expired, copyright expires in accordance with section 22(1).
(4)In relation to—
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 11; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 paras 9, 12(3), (6) (UK)
(1)In relation to a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work (other than a photograph)—
copyright exists until the end of the period of 75 years from the end of the calendar year in which the author died.
(2)In relation to a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work (other than a photograph)—
copyright exists until the expiry of the shorter of the following periods:
Compare: 1962 No 33 s 8(1)(b)
In relation to a literary, dramatic, or musical work or an engraving—
copyright exists until the end of the period of 50 years from the end of the year that includes the earliest occasion on which the work,—
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 6
The provisions of section 26 apply to a work made before commencement if—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 40 (UK)
The provisions of the 1962 Act that specify acts constituting infringements of copyright continue to apply in relation to acts done before commencement.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 14(1) (UK)
The provisions of this Act that specify acts constituting infringements of copyright apply only in relation to acts done after commencement.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 14(1) (UK)
(1)Where a person gave the notice required under the proviso to section 6 of the 1913 Act before the repeal of that section, that proviso and section 22(1) of the 1913 Act shall, in relation to copies of the relevant work made by that person after commencement, have effect as if that proviso and section 22(1) had been re-enacted in this Act as a proviso to section 31.
(2)For the purposes of the operation of the proviso to section 6 of the 1913 Act,—
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 10
For the purposes of section 35, if a person knows or has reason to believe that an object made before commencement and imported by that person into New Zealand after commencement would have been an infringing copy if the question had fallen to be determined under the provisions of the 1962 Act or, as the case may be, the 1913 Act, that person shall be deemed to know or to have reason to believe that the object is an infringing copy under this Act.
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cls 8, 21
Where the acts described in section 41(1)(b) or (c) are done after commencement, it shall be assumed that all the provisions of section 41 were in force at all material times.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 14(4) (UK)
Section 67(1)(b)(ii) applies—
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 15(3) (UK)
Where the acts described in section 73(3) are done after commencement, it shall be assumed that all the provisions of section 73 were in force at all material times.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 14(4) (UK)
(1)No copyright exists in an artistic work that—
(2)For the purposes of subclause (1)(c), a design shall be deemed to have been used, or to be intended to be used, as a model or pattern to be multiplied by any industrial process—
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 9; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 6 (UK)
(1)Nothing in section 74(1) shall apply to or affect—
(2)Where, at commencement, a copy of a literary or artistic work exists, and the making of that copy is excluded by section 74(2) from being authorised by section 74(1), that copy is not an infringing object for the purposes of this Act.
(3)Where, at commencement, a copy of an artistic work exists, and the making of that copy is excluded by section 75(3) from being authorised by section 75(1), that copy is not an infringing object for the purposes of this Act.
(4)Where—
and that reproduction is a reproduction in 2 dimensions reasonably required for the making of the object,—
that object or copy is not an infringing object for the purposes of this Act.
Compare: 1985 No 134 s 4(3)
Copyright does not exist by virtue of any amendment made to the 1962 Act by the 1985 Amendment in any model made before the commencement of the 1985 Amendment.
Compare: 1985 No 134 s 10
In section 78, the reference to the owner of the copyright in the drawings or plans is, in relation to buildings constructed before commencement, to the person who at the time of the construction was the owner of the copyright in the drawings or plans under the 1962 Act, the 1913 Act, or any enactment repealed by the 1913 Act.
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 23(2); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 14(7) (UK)
Section 85 does not apply where the authority to broadcast a work or include it in a cable programme was given before 1 April 1963.
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 22
(1)No act done before commencement is actionable under any provision of Part 4.
(2)Section 62 of the 1962 Act continues to apply in relation to acts done on or after 1 April 1963 and before commencement.
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 37; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 22 (UK)
(1)Subject to subclause (5), the following provisions of this clause have effect in relation to—
(2)The rights described in subclause (1) do not apply—
(3)The rights described in subclause (1) in relation to a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work made before commencement do not apply,—
(4)The rights described in subclause (1) do not apply to anything done in relation to a record made in pursuance of sections 22 and 23 of the 1962 Act.
(5)The rights conferred by section 94 do not apply in respect of any work in which, before commencement, the copyright vested in the employer of the author or director, unless the author or director has previously been identified as such in or on published copies of the work.
(6)In this clause, the term dramatic work includes a film of the kind to which the definition of dramatic work in section 2(1) of the 1913 Act applied.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 23 (UK)
The right conferred by section 105 does not apply to photographs taken or films made before commencement.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 24 (UK)
Section 111(2) does not apply in relation to an exclusive licence granted before commencement.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 29 (UK)
(1)Where copyright exists in a work under the new copyright provisions, any document that—
shall, subject to subclause (2), have the corresponding operation in relation to copyright in the work under the new copyright provisions.
(2)If the operation of any such document was or would have been limited to a period specified in the document, it shall not have any operation in relation to the copyright under the new copyright provisions, except in so far as that period extends beyond commencement.
(3)For the purposes of the operation of a document in accordance with subclause (1),—
(4)Where copyright exists in a work under the new copyright provisions, any event that—
shall have the corresponding operation in relation to copyright in the work under the new copyright provisions.
(5)In this clause,—
copyright in the work under the 1913 Act includes, in relation to a film, any copyright under the 1913 Act in the film in so far as it constituted a dramatic work for the purposes of the 1913 Act and any copyright under the 1913 Act in photographs forming part of the film
operation affecting the title means any operation affecting the ownership of that copyright, or creating, transferring, or terminating an interest, right, or licence in respect of that copyright.
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 36(1), (2), (4)(b), (5); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 paras 25, 26(1) (UK)
(1)Where a document to which clause 37(1) applies is an assignment made or a licence granted—
the assignment or licence shall not be operative to vest in the assignee or licensee any rights with respect to copyright in the work beyond the expiration of 25 years from the death of the author.
(2)After commencement and during the life of the author, the author may assign the reversionary interest in the copyright expectant on the termination of the period specified in subclause (1).
(3)If the author does not make an assignment as permitted by subclause (2), the reversionary interest in the copyright expectant on the termination of the period specified in subclause (1) shall, on the author’s death, devolve on his or her legal personal representatives as part of his or her estate.
(4)Nothing in this clause affects—
(5)Nothing in this clause applies to the assignment of the copyright in a collective work or a licence to publish a work or part of a work as part of a collective work.
(6)In subclause (5), the term collective work means—
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 36(3); Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 27 (UK)
(1)This clause applies where the author of a literary, dramatic, musical, or artistic work published before 1 April 1914 assigned or granted, before 1 April 1914, an interest in the copyright or performing right in the work for the full term of that right under the law in force before the 1913 Act (being such an assignment or grant as was mentioned in paragraph (a) of the proviso to section 32(1) of the 1913 Act).
(2)If, before commencement, any thing was done in relation to the copyright in the work under paragraph (a) of the proviso to section 32(1) of the 1913 Act, that thing has a corresponding operation under the new copyright provisions.
(3)Any right that, before commencement,—
is exercisable in relation to the work or copyright in it under the new copyright provisions.
(4)If, in accordance with paragraph (a) of the proviso to section 32(1) of the 1913 Act, copyright would have reverted to the author or his or her personal representatives on the date referred to in that paragraph, and that date falls after commencement, then, on that date—
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 42; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 28 (UK)
(1)Section 115—
(2)In the case of an author who died before 1 April 1963, the ownership after the author’s death of a manuscript of the author, where such ownership has been acquired under a testamentary disposition made by the author and the manuscript is of a work that has not been published or performed in public, is prima facie proof of the copyright being with the owner of the manuscript.
Compare: Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 30 (UK)
(1)The following provisions apply in relation to an infringement of copyright:
(2)The following provisions apply in relation to the rights and remedies of an exclusive licensee:
(3)The following provisions apply in relation to presumptions:
(4)The following provisions apply in relation to criminal liability for making or dealing with infringing objects:
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cls 25–28; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 paras 31–33 (UK)
(1)Where, before commencement, a person gave notice under section 22(1)(b) of the 1962 Act of his or her intention to make or import a record of a musical work, any making or importing of the record by that person after commencement shall not be an infringement of any copyright in the musical work if the conditions set out in section 22 of the 1962 Act are fulfilled.
(2)The provisions of—
that are in force immediately before commencement shall continue to apply for the purpose of completing or perfecting any matter in progress immediately before commencement.
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 24; Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988 Schedule 1 para 21 (UK)
(1)Subject to subclause (2), where, before commencement, a notice was given in respect of a work under section 29 of the 1962 Act, and that notice had not been withdrawn and had not otherwise ceased to have effect before commencement, the notice shall have effect after commencement as if it had been accepted under section 136, and section 136 shall apply with any necessary modifications.
(2)The notice shall, upon commencement, cease to have any effect in respect of—
Compare: 1962 No 33 Schedule 1 cl 29
Schedule 1 Part 2: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 44(9) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Schedule 1 subpart 2: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 44(9) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Heading:inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 44(9) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
In this subpart, unless the context otherwise requires,—
commencement means the date on which the WIPO performers’ rights provisions come into force
performer’s rights means the rights of a performer conferred by Part 9 of this Act
WIPO performers’ rights provisions means the provisions of Part 1 of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018.
Schedule 1 clause 47: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 44(9) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Heading:inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 44(9) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
(1)If a performance is given on or after commencement, Part 9 (as amended by the WIPO performers’ rights provisions) applies to any act done on or after commencement in relation to that performance.
(2)If a performance is given before commencement, Part 9 (as in force immediately before commencement) continues to apply to any act done on or after commencement in relation to that performance.
(3)Despite subclause (2), if Part 9 (as in force immediately before commencement) would not have applied to an act done, or a performance given, before commencement, subclause (2) and Part 9 do not apply to the act or the performance.
(4)This clause is subject to clauses 49 and 50.
Schedule 1 clause 48: inserted, on 30 December 2018, by section 44(9) of the Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90).
Schedule 1 Part 3: inserted, on 4 January 2020, by section 8 of the Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty
Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43).
In this Part,—
commencement date means the date on which this Part comes into force
former section 69 means section 69 as in force immediately before the commencement date
prescribed body means a body declared in regulation 5 to be a prescribed body for the purposes of former section 69
regulation 5 means regulation 5 of the Copyright (General Matters) Regulations 1995 as in force immediately before the commencement date.
Schedule 1 clause 51: inserted, on 4 January 2020, by section 8 of the Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43).
A copy or an adaptation made or communicated by a prescribed body before the commencement date in compliance with the conditions of the former section 69 is to be treated on and after the commencement date as an accessible format copy that was made or provided in compliance with sections 69A and 69B.
Schedule 1 clause 52: inserted, on 4 January 2020, by section 8 of the Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43).
s 236(1)
Antiquities Act 1975 (1975 No 41) (RS Vol 26, p 31)
Amendment(s) incorporaxted in the Act(s).
Archives Act 1957 (1957 No 13) (RS Vol 1, p 127)
Amendment(s) incorporated in the Act(s).
Commerce Act 1986 (1986 No 5) (RS Vol 31, p 71)
Amendment(s) incorporated in the Act(s).
Disputes Tribunals Act 1988 (1988 No 110)
Amendment(s) incorporated in the Act(s).
Enemy Property Act 1951 (1951 No 48) (RS Vol 6, p 317)
Amendment(s) incorporated in the Act(s).
Films, Videos, and Publications Classification Act 1993 (1993 No 94)
Amendment(s) incorporated in the Act(s).
Layout Designs Act 1994 (1994 No 116)
Amendment(s) incorporated in the Act(s).
Ministry of Agriculture and Fisheries Act 1953 (1953 No 7) (RS Vol 18, p 509)
Amendment(s) incorporated in the Act(s).
National Library Act 1965 (1965 No 136) (RS Vol 11, p 225)
Amendment(s) incorporated in the Act(s).
Public Works Act 1981 (1981 No 35)
Amendment(s) incorporated in the Act(s).
Survey Act 1986 (1986 No 123)
Amendment(s) incorporated in the Act(s).
s 236(2)
Broadcasting Act 1989 (1989 No 25)
Amendment(s) incorporated in the Act(s).
Copyright Act 1962 (1962 No 33)
Copyright Amendment Act 1967 (1967 No 65)
Copyright Amendment Act 1971 (1971 No 91)
Copyright Amendment Act 1985 (1985 No 134)
Copyright Amendment Act 1986 (1986 No 81)
Copyright Amendment Act 1989 (1989 No 112)
Copyright Amendment Act 1990 (1990 No 71)
Decimal Currency Act 1964 (1964 No 27)
Amendment(s) incorporated in the Act(s).
Summary Proceedings Act 1957 (1957 No 87)
Amendment(s) incorporated in the Act(s).
s 236(3)
Copyright Amending Regulations 1946 (SR 1946/142)
Copyright Amending Regulations 1955 (SR 1955/45)
Copyright (Customs) Regulations 1963 (SR 1963/85)
Copyright (International Conventions) Order 1964 (SR 1964/53)
Copyright (International Conventions) Order 1964, Amendment No 1 (SR
1979/64)
Copyright (Record Royalties) Regulations 1963 (SR 1963/84)
Copyright Regulations 1913 (Gazette Vol I 1914, p 1325)
Works the Importation of which is prohibited under the Copyright Act 1913
(Gazette Vol I 1925, p 16)
1General
This is a consolidation of the Copyright Act 1994 that incorporates the amendments made to the legislation so that it shows the law as at its stated date.
2General
A consolidation is taken to correctly state, as at its stated date, the law enacted or made by the legislation consolidated and by the amendments. This presumption applies unless the contrary is shown.
Section 78 of the Legislation Act 2019 provides that this consolidation, published as an electronic version, is an official version. A printed version of legislation that is produced directly from this official electronic version is also an official version.
3Editorial and format changes
The Parliamentary Counsel Office makes editorial and format changes to consolidations using the powers under subpart 2 of Part 3 of the Legislation Act 2019. See also PCO editorial conventions for consolidations.
4Amendments incorporated in this consolidation
United Kingdom Free Trade Agreement Legislation Act 2022 (2022 No 59): Part 1
Te Ture mō te Hararei Tūmatanui o te Kāhui o Matariki 2022/Te Kāhui o Matariki Public Holiday Act 2022 (2022 No 14): wehenga 7/section 7
Secondary Legislation Act 2021 (2021 No 7): section 3
Public Service Act 2020 (2020 No 40): section 135
Education and Training Act 2020 (2020 No 38): section 668
Copyright (Marrakesh Treaty Implementation) Amendment Act 2019 (2019 No 43): Part 1
Tribunals Powers and Procedures Legislation Act 2018 (2018 No 51): Part 1 subpart 2
Customs and Excise Act 2018 (2018 No 4): section 443(3)
Electronic Interactions Reform Act 2017 (2017 No 50): Part 3 subpart 3
Comprehensive and Progressive Agreement for Trans-Pacific Partnership Amendment Act 2018 (2016 No 90): Part 1 (as amended by Trans-Pacific Partnership Agreement (CPTPP) Amendment Act 2018)
Copyright Amendment Act 2016 (2016 No 59)
District Court Act 2016 (2016 No 49): section 261
Standards and Accreditation Act 2015 (2015 No 91): section 44
Copyright (Infringing File Sharing and Cellular Mobile Networks) Order 2015 (LI 2015/208)
Copyright Amendment Act 2015 (2015 No 11)
Copyright (Parallel Importing of Films) Amendment Act 2013 (2013 No 86)
Criminal Procedure (Consequential Amendments) Regulations 2013 (SR 2013/409): regulation 3(1)
Patents Act 2013 (2013 No 68): section 249
Inquiries Act 2013 (2013 No 60): section 39
Holidays (Full Recognition of Waitangi Day and ANZAC Day) Amendment Act 2013 (2013 No 19): section 8
Legislation Act 2012 (2012 No 119): section 77(3)
Criminal Procedure Act 2011 (2011 No 81): section 413
Copyright Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 72)
Television New Zealand Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 52): section 14
Copyright (Infringing File Sharing) Amendment Act 2011 (2011 No 11)
Copyright Amendment Act 2010 (2010 No 55)
Designs Amendment Act 2010 (2010 No 15): section 8
Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 Commencement Amendment Order (No 2) 2009 (SR 2009/51)
Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 Commencement Order (No 2) 2008 (SR
2008/411)
Policing Act 2008 (2008 No 72): section 116(a)(ii)
Copyright (New Technologies) Amendment Act 2008 (2008 No 27)
Evidence Act 2006 (2006 No 69): section 216
Insolvency Act 2006 (2006 No 55): section 445
Lawyers and Conveyancers Act 2006 (2006 No 1): section 348
Public Records Act 2005 (2005 No 40): section 67(1)
Copyright Amendment Act 2005 (2005 No 33)
Copyright (Parallel Importation of Films and Onus of Proof) Amendment Act 2003 (2003 No 111)
Trade Marks Act 2002 (2002 No 49): section 201
Sentencing Act 2002 (2002 No 9): section 186
Public Trust Act 2001 (2001 No 100): section 170(1)
Public Audit Act 2001 (2001 No 10): section 53
Copyright Act Commencement Order 2000 (SR 2000/245)
Copyright Amendment Act 1999 (1999 No 124)
Copyright (Removal of Prohibition on Parallel Importing) Amendment Act 1998 (1998 No 20)
Copyright Amendment Act 1997 (1997 No 38)
Copyright Amendment Act 1996 (1996 No 28)
Customs and Excise Act 1996 (1996 No 27): section 289(1)
Department of Justice (Restructuring) Act 1995 (1995 No 39): section 10(3)
Copyright Act 1994 (1994 No 143): section 35(5)
__________________
Wellington, New Zealand:
Published under the authority of the New Zealand Government—2023